blob: a73234efdc6130fc6a41574328f503844a20973d [file] [log] [blame]
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001#
Wolfgang Denkb75190d2012-01-19 10:58:21 +01002# (C) Copyright 2000 - 2012
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003# Wolfgang Denk, DENX Software Engineering, wd@denx.de.
4#
5# See file CREDITS for list of people who contributed to this
6# project.
7#
8# This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or
9# modify it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as
10# published by the Free Software Foundation; either version 2 of
11# the License, or (at your option) any later version.
12#
13# This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
14# but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
15# MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the
16# GNU General Public License for more details.
17#
18# You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
19# along with this program; if not, write to the Free Software
20# Foundation, Inc., 59 Temple Place, Suite 330, Boston,
21# MA 02111-1307 USA
22#
23
24Summary:
25========
26
wdenk24ee89b2002-11-03 17:56:27 +000027This directory contains the source code for U-Boot, a boot loader for
wdenke86e5a02004-10-17 21:12:06 +000028Embedded boards based on PowerPC, ARM, MIPS and several other
29processors, which can be installed in a boot ROM and used to
30initialize and test the hardware or to download and run application
31code.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +000032
33The development of U-Boot is closely related to Linux: some parts of
wdenk24ee89b2002-11-03 17:56:27 +000034the source code originate in the Linux source tree, we have some
35header files in common, and special provision has been made to
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +000036support booting of Linux images.
37
38Some attention has been paid to make this software easily
39configurable and extendable. For instance, all monitor commands are
40implemented with the same call interface, so that it's very easy to
41add new commands. Also, instead of permanently adding rarely used
42code (for instance hardware test utilities) to the monitor, you can
43load and run it dynamically.
44
45
46Status:
47=======
48
49In general, all boards for which a configuration option exists in the
wdenk24ee89b2002-11-03 17:56:27 +000050Makefile have been tested to some extent and can be considered
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +000051"working". In fact, many of them are used in production systems.
52
wdenk24ee89b2002-11-03 17:56:27 +000053In case of problems see the CHANGELOG and CREDITS files to find out
Wolfgang Denk218ca722008-03-26 10:40:12 +010054who contributed the specific port. The MAINTAINERS file lists board
55maintainers.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +000056
Robert P. J. Dayadb9d852012-11-14 02:03:20 +000057Note: There is no CHANGELOG file in the actual U-Boot source tree;
58it can be created dynamically from the Git log using:
59
60 make CHANGELOG
61
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +000062
63Where to get help:
64==================
65
wdenk24ee89b2002-11-03 17:56:27 +000066In case you have questions about, problems with or contributions for
67U-Boot you should send a message to the U-Boot mailing list at
Peter Tyser0c325652008-09-10 09:18:34 -050068<u-boot@lists.denx.de>. There is also an archive of previous traffic
69on the mailing list - please search the archive before asking FAQ's.
70Please see http://lists.denx.de/pipermail/u-boot and
71http://dir.gmane.org/gmane.comp.boot-loaders.u-boot
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +000072
73
Wolfgang Denk218ca722008-03-26 10:40:12 +010074Where to get source code:
75=========================
76
77The U-Boot source code is maintained in the git repository at
78git://www.denx.de/git/u-boot.git ; you can browse it online at
79http://www.denx.de/cgi-bin/gitweb.cgi?p=u-boot.git;a=summary
80
81The "snapshot" links on this page allow you to download tarballs of
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +020082any version you might be interested in. Official releases are also
Wolfgang Denk218ca722008-03-26 10:40:12 +010083available for FTP download from the ftp://ftp.denx.de/pub/u-boot/
84directory.
85
Anatolij Gustschind4ee7112008-03-26 18:13:33 +010086Pre-built (and tested) images are available from
Wolfgang Denk218ca722008-03-26 10:40:12 +010087ftp://ftp.denx.de/pub/u-boot/images/
88
89
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +000090Where we come from:
91===================
92
93- start from 8xxrom sources
wdenk24ee89b2002-11-03 17:56:27 +000094- create PPCBoot project (http://sourceforge.net/projects/ppcboot)
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +000095- clean up code
96- make it easier to add custom boards
97- make it possible to add other [PowerPC] CPUs
98- extend functions, especially:
99 * Provide extended interface to Linux boot loader
100 * S-Record download
101 * network boot
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +0200102 * PCMCIA / CompactFlash / ATA disk / SCSI ... boot
wdenk24ee89b2002-11-03 17:56:27 +0000103- create ARMBoot project (http://sourceforge.net/projects/armboot)
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000104- add other CPU families (starting with ARM)
wdenk24ee89b2002-11-03 17:56:27 +0000105- create U-Boot project (http://sourceforge.net/projects/u-boot)
Magnus Lilja0d28f342008-08-06 19:32:33 +0200106- current project page: see http://www.denx.de/wiki/U-Boot
wdenk24ee89b2002-11-03 17:56:27 +0000107
108
109Names and Spelling:
110===================
111
112The "official" name of this project is "Das U-Boot". The spelling
113"U-Boot" shall be used in all written text (documentation, comments
114in source files etc.). Example:
115
116 This is the README file for the U-Boot project.
117
118File names etc. shall be based on the string "u-boot". Examples:
119
120 include/asm-ppc/u-boot.h
121
122 #include <asm/u-boot.h>
123
124Variable names, preprocessor constants etc. shall be either based on
125the string "u_boot" or on "U_BOOT". Example:
126
127 U_BOOT_VERSION u_boot_logo
128 IH_OS_U_BOOT u_boot_hush_start
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000129
130
wdenk93f19cc2002-12-17 17:55:09 +0000131Versioning:
132===========
133
Thomas Weber360d8832010-09-28 08:06:25 +0200134Starting with the release in October 2008, the names of the releases
135were changed from numerical release numbers without deeper meaning
136into a time stamp based numbering. Regular releases are identified by
137names consisting of the calendar year and month of the release date.
138Additional fields (if present) indicate release candidates or bug fix
139releases in "stable" maintenance trees.
wdenk93f19cc2002-12-17 17:55:09 +0000140
Thomas Weber360d8832010-09-28 08:06:25 +0200141Examples:
Wolfgang Denkc0f40852011-10-26 10:21:21 +0000142 U-Boot v2009.11 - Release November 2009
Thomas Weber360d8832010-09-28 08:06:25 +0200143 U-Boot v2009.11.1 - Release 1 in version November 2009 stable tree
144 U-Boot v2010.09-rc1 - Release candiate 1 for September 2010 release
wdenk93f19cc2002-12-17 17:55:09 +0000145
146
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000147Directory Hierarchy:
148====================
149
Peter Tyser8d321b82010-04-12 22:28:21 -0500150/arch Architecture specific files
151 /arm Files generic to ARM architecture
152 /cpu CPU specific files
153 /arm720t Files specific to ARM 720 CPUs
154 /arm920t Files specific to ARM 920 CPUs
Andreas Bießmann6eb09212011-07-18 09:41:08 +0000155 /at91 Files specific to Atmel AT91RM9200 CPU
Wolfgang Denka9046b92010-06-13 17:48:15 +0200156 /imx Files specific to Freescale MC9328 i.MX CPUs
157 /s3c24x0 Files specific to Samsung S3C24X0 CPUs
Peter Tyser8d321b82010-04-12 22:28:21 -0500158 /arm925t Files specific to ARM 925 CPUs
159 /arm926ejs Files specific to ARM 926 CPUs
160 /arm1136 Files specific to ARM 1136 CPUs
161 /ixp Files specific to Intel XScale IXP CPUs
162 /pxa Files specific to Intel XScale PXA CPUs
163 /s3c44b0 Files specific to Samsung S3C44B0 CPUs
164 /sa1100 Files specific to Intel StrongARM SA1100 CPUs
165 /lib Architecture specific library files
166 /avr32 Files generic to AVR32 architecture
167 /cpu CPU specific files
168 /lib Architecture specific library files
169 /blackfin Files generic to Analog Devices Blackfin architecture
170 /cpu CPU specific files
171 /lib Architecture specific library files
Graeme Russfea25722011-04-13 19:43:28 +1000172 /x86 Files generic to x86 architecture
Peter Tyser8d321b82010-04-12 22:28:21 -0500173 /cpu CPU specific files
174 /lib Architecture specific library files
175 /m68k Files generic to m68k architecture
176 /cpu CPU specific files
177 /mcf52x2 Files specific to Freescale ColdFire MCF52x2 CPUs
178 /mcf5227x Files specific to Freescale ColdFire MCF5227x CPUs
179 /mcf532x Files specific to Freescale ColdFire MCF5329 CPUs
180 /mcf5445x Files specific to Freescale ColdFire MCF5445x CPUs
181 /mcf547x_8x Files specific to Freescale ColdFire MCF547x_8x CPUs
182 /lib Architecture specific library files
183 /microblaze Files generic to microblaze architecture
184 /cpu CPU specific files
185 /lib Architecture specific library files
186 /mips Files generic to MIPS architecture
187 /cpu CPU specific files
Daniel Schwierzeck92bbd642011-07-27 13:22:39 +0200188 /mips32 Files specific to MIPS32 CPUs
Xiangfu Liu80421fc2011-10-12 12:24:06 +0800189 /xburst Files specific to Ingenic XBurst CPUs
Peter Tyser8d321b82010-04-12 22:28:21 -0500190 /lib Architecture specific library files
Macpaul Linafc1ce82011-10-19 20:41:11 +0000191 /nds32 Files generic to NDS32 architecture
192 /cpu CPU specific files
193 /n1213 Files specific to Andes Technology N1213 CPUs
194 /lib Architecture specific library files
Peter Tyser8d321b82010-04-12 22:28:21 -0500195 /nios2 Files generic to Altera NIOS2 architecture
196 /cpu CPU specific files
197 /lib Architecture specific library files
Stefan Roesea47a12b2010-04-15 16:07:28 +0200198 /powerpc Files generic to PowerPC architecture
Peter Tyser8d321b82010-04-12 22:28:21 -0500199 /cpu CPU specific files
200 /74xx_7xx Files specific to Freescale MPC74xx and 7xx CPUs
201 /mpc5xx Files specific to Freescale MPC5xx CPUs
202 /mpc5xxx Files specific to Freescale MPC5xxx CPUs
203 /mpc8xx Files specific to Freescale MPC8xx CPUs
204 /mpc8220 Files specific to Freescale MPC8220 CPUs
205 /mpc824x Files specific to Freescale MPC824x CPUs
206 /mpc8260 Files specific to Freescale MPC8260 CPUs
207 /mpc85xx Files specific to Freescale MPC85xx CPUs
208 /ppc4xx Files specific to AMCC PowerPC 4xx CPUs
209 /lib Architecture specific library files
210 /sh Files generic to SH architecture
211 /cpu CPU specific files
212 /sh2 Files specific to sh2 CPUs
213 /sh3 Files specific to sh3 CPUs
214 /sh4 Files specific to sh4 CPUs
215 /lib Architecture specific library files
216 /sparc Files generic to SPARC architecture
217 /cpu CPU specific files
218 /leon2 Files specific to Gaisler LEON2 SPARC CPU
219 /leon3 Files specific to Gaisler LEON3 SPARC CPU
220 /lib Architecture specific library files
221/api Machine/arch independent API for external apps
222/board Board dependent files
223/common Misc architecture independent functions
224/disk Code for disk drive partition handling
225/doc Documentation (don't expect too much)
226/drivers Commonly used device drivers
227/examples Example code for standalone applications, etc.
228/fs Filesystem code (cramfs, ext2, jffs2, etc.)
229/include Header Files
230/lib Files generic to all architectures
231 /libfdt Library files to support flattened device trees
232 /lzma Library files to support LZMA decompression
233 /lzo Library files to support LZO decompression
234/net Networking code
235/post Power On Self Test
236/rtc Real Time Clock drivers
237/tools Tools to build S-Record or U-Boot images, etc.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000238
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000239Software Configuration:
240=======================
241
242Configuration is usually done using C preprocessor defines; the
243rationale behind that is to avoid dead code whenever possible.
244
245There are two classes of configuration variables:
246
247* Configuration _OPTIONS_:
248 These are selectable by the user and have names beginning with
249 "CONFIG_".
250
251* Configuration _SETTINGS_:
252 These depend on the hardware etc. and should not be meddled with if
253 you don't know what you're doing; they have names beginning with
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +0200254 "CONFIG_SYS_".
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000255
256Later we will add a configuration tool - probably similar to or even
257identical to what's used for the Linux kernel. Right now, we have to
258do the configuration by hand, which means creating some symbolic
259links and editing some configuration files. We use the TQM8xxL boards
260as an example here.
261
262
263Selection of Processor Architecture and Board Type:
264---------------------------------------------------
265
266For all supported boards there are ready-to-use default
267configurations available; just type "make <board_name>_config".
268
269Example: For a TQM823L module type:
270
271 cd u-boot
272 make TQM823L_config
273
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +0200274For the Cogent platform, you need to specify the CPU type as well;
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000275e.g. "make cogent_mpc8xx_config". And also configure the cogent
276directory according to the instructions in cogent/README.
277
278
279Configuration Options:
280----------------------
281
282Configuration depends on the combination of board and CPU type; all
283such information is kept in a configuration file
284"include/configs/<board_name>.h".
285
286Example: For a TQM823L module, all configuration settings are in
287"include/configs/TQM823L.h".
288
289
wdenk7f6c2cb2002-11-10 22:06:23 +0000290Many of the options are named exactly as the corresponding Linux
291kernel configuration options. The intention is to make it easier to
292build a config tool - later.
293
294
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000295The following options need to be configured:
296
Kim Phillips26281142007-08-10 13:28:25 -0500297- CPU Type: Define exactly one, e.g. CONFIG_MPC85XX.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000298
Kim Phillips26281142007-08-10 13:28:25 -0500299- Board Type: Define exactly one, e.g. CONFIG_MPC8540ADS.
Wolfgang Denk6ccec442006-10-24 14:42:37 +0200300
301- CPU Daughterboard Type: (if CONFIG_ATSTK1000 is defined)
Haavard Skinnemoen09ea0de2007-11-01 12:44:20 +0100302 Define exactly one, e.g. CONFIG_ATSTK1002
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000303
304- CPU Module Type: (if CONFIG_COGENT is defined)
305 Define exactly one of
306 CONFIG_CMA286_60_OLD
307--- FIXME --- not tested yet:
308 CONFIG_CMA286_60, CONFIG_CMA286_21, CONFIG_CMA286_60P,
309 CONFIG_CMA287_23, CONFIG_CMA287_50
310
311- Motherboard Type: (if CONFIG_COGENT is defined)
312 Define exactly one of
313 CONFIG_CMA101, CONFIG_CMA102
314
315- Motherboard I/O Modules: (if CONFIG_COGENT is defined)
316 Define one or more of
317 CONFIG_CMA302
318
319- Motherboard Options: (if CONFIG_CMA101 or CONFIG_CMA102 are defined)
320 Define one or more of
321 CONFIG_LCD_HEARTBEAT - update a character position on
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +0200322 the LCD display every second with
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000323 a "rotator" |\-/|\-/
324
wdenk2535d602003-07-17 23:16:40 +0000325- Board flavour: (if CONFIG_MPC8260ADS is defined)
326 CONFIG_ADSTYPE
327 Possible values are:
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +0200328 CONFIG_SYS_8260ADS - original MPC8260ADS
329 CONFIG_SYS_8266ADS - MPC8266ADS
330 CONFIG_SYS_PQ2FADS - PQ2FADS-ZU or PQ2FADS-VR
331 CONFIG_SYS_8272ADS - MPC8272ADS
wdenk2535d602003-07-17 23:16:40 +0000332
Lei Wencf946c62011-02-09 18:06:58 +0530333- Marvell Family Member
334 CONFIG_SYS_MVFS - define it if you want to enable
335 multiple fs option at one time
336 for marvell soc family
337
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000338- MPC824X Family Member (if CONFIG_MPC824X is defined)
wdenk5da627a2003-10-09 20:09:04 +0000339 Define exactly one of
340 CONFIG_MPC8240, CONFIG_MPC8245
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000341
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +0200342- 8xx CPU Options: (if using an MPC8xx CPU)
wdenk66ca92a2004-09-28 17:59:53 +0000343 CONFIG_8xx_GCLK_FREQ - deprecated: CPU clock if
344 get_gclk_freq() cannot work
wdenk5da627a2003-10-09 20:09:04 +0000345 e.g. if there is no 32KHz
346 reference PIT/RTC clock
wdenk66ca92a2004-09-28 17:59:53 +0000347 CONFIG_8xx_OSCLK - PLL input clock (either EXTCLK
348 or XTAL/EXTAL)
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000349
wdenk66ca92a2004-09-28 17:59:53 +0000350- 859/866/885 CPU options: (if using a MPC859 or MPC866 or MPC885 CPU):
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +0200351 CONFIG_SYS_8xx_CPUCLK_MIN
352 CONFIG_SYS_8xx_CPUCLK_MAX
wdenk66ca92a2004-09-28 17:59:53 +0000353 CONFIG_8xx_CPUCLK_DEFAULT
wdenk75d1ea72004-01-31 20:06:54 +0000354 See doc/README.MPC866
355
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +0200356 CONFIG_SYS_MEASURE_CPUCLK
wdenk75d1ea72004-01-31 20:06:54 +0000357
wdenkba56f622004-02-06 23:19:44 +0000358 Define this to measure the actual CPU clock instead
359 of relying on the correctness of the configured
360 values. Mostly useful for board bringup to make sure
361 the PLL is locked at the intended frequency. Note
362 that this requires a (stable) reference clock (32 kHz
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +0200363 RTC clock or CONFIG_SYS_8XX_XIN)
wdenk75d1ea72004-01-31 20:06:54 +0000364
Heiko Schocher506f3912009-03-12 07:37:15 +0100365 CONFIG_SYS_DELAYED_ICACHE
366
367 Define this option if you want to enable the
368 ICache only when Code runs from RAM.
369
Kumar Gala66412c62011-02-18 05:40:54 -0600370- 85xx CPU Options:
York Sunffd06e02012-10-08 07:44:30 +0000371 CONFIG_SYS_PPC64
372
373 Specifies that the core is a 64-bit PowerPC implementation (implements
374 the "64" category of the Power ISA). This is necessary for ePAPR
375 compliance, among other possible reasons.
376
Kumar Gala66412c62011-02-18 05:40:54 -0600377 CONFIG_SYS_FSL_TBCLK_DIV
378
379 Defines the core time base clock divider ratio compared to the
380 system clock. On most PQ3 devices this is 8, on newer QorIQ
381 devices it can be 16 or 32. The ratio varies from SoC to Soc.
382
Kumar Gala8f290842011-05-20 00:39:21 -0500383 CONFIG_SYS_FSL_PCIE_COMPAT
384
385 Defines the string to utilize when trying to match PCIe device
386 tree nodes for the given platform.
387
Prabhakar Kushwahaafa6b552012-04-29 23:56:13 +0000388 CONFIG_SYS_PPC_E500_DEBUG_TLB
389
390 Enables a temporary TLB entry to be used during boot to work
391 around limitations in e500v1 and e500v2 external debugger
392 support. This reduces the portions of the boot code where
393 breakpoints and single stepping do not work. The value of this
394 symbol should be set to the TLB1 entry to be used for this
395 purpose.
396
Scott Wood33eee332012-08-14 10:14:53 +0000397 CONFIG_SYS_FSL_ERRATUM_A004510
398
399 Enables a workaround for erratum A004510. If set,
400 then CONFIG_SYS_FSL_ERRATUM_A004510_SVR_REV and
401 CONFIG_SYS_FSL_CORENET_SNOOPVEC_COREONLY must be set.
402
403 CONFIG_SYS_FSL_ERRATUM_A004510_SVR_REV
404 CONFIG_SYS_FSL_ERRATUM_A004510_SVR_REV2 (optional)
405
406 Defines one or two SoC revisions (low 8 bits of SVR)
407 for which the A004510 workaround should be applied.
408
409 The rest of SVR is either not relevant to the decision
410 of whether the erratum is present (e.g. p2040 versus
411 p2041) or is implied by the build target, which controls
412 whether CONFIG_SYS_FSL_ERRATUM_A004510 is set.
413
414 See Freescale App Note 4493 for more information about
415 this erratum.
416
417 CONFIG_SYS_FSL_CORENET_SNOOPVEC_COREONLY
418
419 This is the value to write into CCSR offset 0x18600
420 according to the A004510 workaround.
421
Daniel Schwierzeck6cb461b2012-04-02 02:57:56 +0000422- Generic CPU options:
423 CONFIG_SYS_BIG_ENDIAN, CONFIG_SYS_LITTLE_ENDIAN
424
425 Defines the endianess of the CPU. Implementation of those
426 values is arch specific.
427
Markus Klotzbuecher0b953ff2006-03-24 15:28:02 +0100428- Intel Monahans options:
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +0200429 CONFIG_SYS_MONAHANS_RUN_MODE_OSC_RATIO
Markus Klotzbuecher0b953ff2006-03-24 15:28:02 +0100430
431 Defines the Monahans run mode to oscillator
432 ratio. Valid values are 8, 16, 24, 31. The core
433 frequency is this value multiplied by 13 MHz.
434
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +0200435 CONFIG_SYS_MONAHANS_TURBO_RUN_MODE_RATIO
Wolfgang Denkcf48eb92006-04-16 10:51:58 +0200436
Markus Klotzbuecher0b953ff2006-03-24 15:28:02 +0100437 Defines the Monahans turbo mode to oscillator
438 ratio. Valid values are 1 (default if undefined) and
Wolfgang Denkcf48eb92006-04-16 10:51:58 +0200439 2. The core frequency as calculated above is multiplied
Markus Klotzbuecher0b953ff2006-03-24 15:28:02 +0100440 by this value.
Wolfgang Denkcf48eb92006-04-16 10:51:58 +0200441
Daniel Schwierzeck92bbd642011-07-27 13:22:39 +0200442- MIPS CPU options:
443 CONFIG_SYS_INIT_SP_OFFSET
444
445 Offset relative to CONFIG_SYS_SDRAM_BASE for initial stack
446 pointer. This is needed for the temporary stack before
447 relocation.
448
449 CONFIG_SYS_MIPS_CACHE_MODE
450
451 Cache operation mode for the MIPS CPU.
452 See also arch/mips/include/asm/mipsregs.h.
453 Possible values are:
454 CONF_CM_CACHABLE_NO_WA
455 CONF_CM_CACHABLE_WA
456 CONF_CM_UNCACHED
457 CONF_CM_CACHABLE_NONCOHERENT
458 CONF_CM_CACHABLE_CE
459 CONF_CM_CACHABLE_COW
460 CONF_CM_CACHABLE_CUW
461 CONF_CM_CACHABLE_ACCELERATED
462
463 CONFIG_SYS_XWAY_EBU_BOOTCFG
464
465 Special option for Lantiq XWAY SoCs for booting from NOR flash.
466 See also arch/mips/cpu/mips32/start.S.
467
468 CONFIG_XWAY_SWAP_BYTES
469
470 Enable compilation of tools/xway-swap-bytes needed for Lantiq
471 XWAY SoCs for booting from NOR flash. The U-Boot image needs to
472 be swapped if a flash programmer is used.
473
Christian Rieschb67d8812012-02-02 00:44:39 +0000474- ARM options:
475 CONFIG_SYS_EXCEPTION_VECTORS_HIGH
476
477 Select high exception vectors of the ARM core, e.g., do not
478 clear the V bit of the c1 register of CP15.
479
Aneesh V5356f542012-03-08 07:20:19 +0000480 CONFIG_SYS_THUMB_BUILD
481
482 Use this flag to build U-Boot using the Thumb instruction
483 set for ARM architectures. Thumb instruction set provides
484 better code density. For ARM architectures that support
485 Thumb2 this flag will result in Thumb2 code generated by
486 GCC.
487
Stephen Warren06785872013-02-26 12:28:27 +0000488 CONFIG_ARM_ERRATA_742230
489 CONFIG_ARM_ERRATA_743622
490 CONFIG_ARM_ERRATA_751472
491
492 If set, the workarounds for these ARM errata are applied early
493 during U-Boot startup. Note that these options force the
494 workarounds to be applied; no CPU-type/version detection
495 exists, unlike the similar options in the Linux kernel. Do not
496 set these options unless they apply!
497
wdenk5da627a2003-10-09 20:09:04 +0000498- Linux Kernel Interface:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000499 CONFIG_CLOCKS_IN_MHZ
500
501 U-Boot stores all clock information in Hz
502 internally. For binary compatibility with older Linux
503 kernels (which expect the clocks passed in the
504 bd_info data to be in MHz) the environment variable
505 "clocks_in_mhz" can be defined so that U-Boot
506 converts clock data to MHZ before passing it to the
507 Linux kernel.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000508 When CONFIG_CLOCKS_IN_MHZ is defined, a definition of
Wolfgang Denk218ca722008-03-26 10:40:12 +0100509 "clocks_in_mhz=1" is automatically included in the
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000510 default environment.
511
wdenk5da627a2003-10-09 20:09:04 +0000512 CONFIG_MEMSIZE_IN_BYTES [relevant for MIPS only]
513
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +0200514 When transferring memsize parameter to linux, some versions
wdenk5da627a2003-10-09 20:09:04 +0000515 expect it to be in bytes, others in MB.
516 Define CONFIG_MEMSIZE_IN_BYTES to make it in bytes.
517
Gerald Van Barenfec6d9e2008-06-03 20:34:45 -0400518 CONFIG_OF_LIBFDT
Wolfgang Denkf57f70a2005-10-13 01:45:54 +0200519
520 New kernel versions are expecting firmware settings to be
Gerald Van Baren213bf8c2007-03-31 12:23:51 -0400521 passed using flattened device trees (based on open firmware
522 concepts).
523
524 CONFIG_OF_LIBFDT
525 * New libfdt-based support
526 * Adds the "fdt" command
Kim Phillips3bb342f2007-08-10 14:34:14 -0500527 * The bootm command automatically updates the fdt
Gerald Van Baren213bf8c2007-03-31 12:23:51 -0400528
Marcel Ziswilerb55ae402009-09-09 21:18:41 +0200529 OF_CPU - The proper name of the cpus node (only required for
530 MPC512X and MPC5xxx based boards).
531 OF_SOC - The proper name of the soc node (only required for
532 MPC512X and MPC5xxx based boards).
Wolfgang Denkf57f70a2005-10-13 01:45:54 +0200533 OF_TBCLK - The timebase frequency.
Kumar Galac2871f02006-01-11 13:59:02 -0600534 OF_STDOUT_PATH - The path to the console device
Wolfgang Denkf57f70a2005-10-13 01:45:54 +0200535
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +0200536 boards with QUICC Engines require OF_QE to set UCC MAC
537 addresses
Kim Phillips3bb342f2007-08-10 14:34:14 -0500538
Kumar Gala4e253132006-01-11 13:54:17 -0600539 CONFIG_OF_BOARD_SETUP
540
541 Board code has addition modification that it wants to make
542 to the flat device tree before handing it off to the kernel
wdenk6705d812004-08-02 23:22:59 +0000543
Matthew McClintock02677682006-06-28 10:41:37 -0500544 CONFIG_OF_BOOT_CPU
545
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +0200546 This define fills in the correct boot CPU in the boot
Matthew McClintock02677682006-06-28 10:41:37 -0500547 param header, the default value is zero if undefined.
548
Heiko Schocher3887c3f2009-09-23 07:56:08 +0200549 CONFIG_OF_IDE_FIXUP
550
551 U-Boot can detect if an IDE device is present or not.
552 If not, and this new config option is activated, U-Boot
553 removes the ATA node from the DTS before booting Linux,
554 so the Linux IDE driver does not probe the device and
555 crash. This is needed for buggy hardware (uc101) where
556 no pull down resistor is connected to the signal IDE5V_DD7.
557
Igor Grinberg7eb29392011-07-14 05:45:07 +0000558 CONFIG_MACH_TYPE [relevant for ARM only][mandatory]
559
560 This setting is mandatory for all boards that have only one
561 machine type and must be used to specify the machine type
562 number as it appears in the ARM machine registry
563 (see http://www.arm.linux.org.uk/developer/machines/).
564 Only boards that have multiple machine types supported
565 in a single configuration file and the machine type is
566 runtime discoverable, do not have to use this setting.
567
Niklaus Giger0b2f4ec2008-11-03 22:13:47 +0100568- vxWorks boot parameters:
569
570 bootvx constructs a valid bootline using the following
571 environments variables: bootfile, ipaddr, serverip, hostname.
572 It loads the vxWorks image pointed bootfile.
573
574 CONFIG_SYS_VXWORKS_BOOT_DEVICE - The vxworks device name
575 CONFIG_SYS_VXWORKS_MAC_PTR - Ethernet 6 byte MA -address
576 CONFIG_SYS_VXWORKS_SERVERNAME - Name of the server
577 CONFIG_SYS_VXWORKS_BOOT_ADDR - Address of boot parameters
578
579 CONFIG_SYS_VXWORKS_ADD_PARAMS
580
581 Add it at the end of the bootline. E.g "u=username pw=secret"
582
583 Note: If a "bootargs" environment is defined, it will overwride
584 the defaults discussed just above.
585
Aneesh V2c451f72011-06-16 23:30:47 +0000586- Cache Configuration:
587 CONFIG_SYS_ICACHE_OFF - Do not enable instruction cache in U-Boot
588 CONFIG_SYS_DCACHE_OFF - Do not enable data cache in U-Boot
589 CONFIG_SYS_L2CACHE_OFF- Do not enable L2 cache in U-Boot
590
Aneesh V93bc2192011-06-16 23:30:51 +0000591- Cache Configuration for ARM:
592 CONFIG_SYS_L2_PL310 - Enable support for ARM PL310 L2 cache
593 controller
594 CONFIG_SYS_PL310_BASE - Physical base address of PL310
595 controller register space
596
wdenk6705d812004-08-02 23:22:59 +0000597- Serial Ports:
Andreas Engel48d01922008-09-08 14:30:53 +0200598 CONFIG_PL010_SERIAL
wdenk6705d812004-08-02 23:22:59 +0000599
600 Define this if you want support for Amba PrimeCell PL010 UARTs.
601
Andreas Engel48d01922008-09-08 14:30:53 +0200602 CONFIG_PL011_SERIAL
wdenk6705d812004-08-02 23:22:59 +0000603
604 Define this if you want support for Amba PrimeCell PL011 UARTs.
605
606 CONFIG_PL011_CLOCK
607
608 If you have Amba PrimeCell PL011 UARTs, set this variable to
609 the clock speed of the UARTs.
610
611 CONFIG_PL01x_PORTS
612
613 If you have Amba PrimeCell PL010 or PL011 UARTs on your board,
614 define this to a list of base addresses for each (supported)
615 port. See e.g. include/configs/versatile.h
616
John Rigby910f1ae2011-04-19 10:42:39 +0000617 CONFIG_PL011_SERIAL_RLCR
618
619 Some vendor versions of PL011 serial ports (e.g. ST-Ericsson U8500)
620 have separate receive and transmit line control registers. Set
621 this variable to initialize the extra register.
622
623 CONFIG_PL011_SERIAL_FLUSH_ON_INIT
624
625 On some platforms (e.g. U8500) U-Boot is loaded by a second stage
626 boot loader that has already initialized the UART. Define this
627 variable to flush the UART at init time.
628
Javier Martinez Canillas7de0fe12013-01-07 01:35:20 +0000629 CONFIG_SYS_NS16550_BROKEN_TEMT
630
631 16550 UART set the Transmitter Empty (TEMT) Bit when all output
632 has finished and the transmitter is totally empty. U-Boot waits
633 for this bit to be set to initialize the serial console. On some
634 broken platforms this bit is not set in SPL making U-Boot to
635 hang while waiting for TEMT. Define this option to avoid it.
636
wdenk6705d812004-08-02 23:22:59 +0000637
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000638- Console Interface:
wdenk43d96162003-03-06 00:02:04 +0000639 Depending on board, define exactly one serial port
640 (like CONFIG_8xx_CONS_SMC1, CONFIG_8xx_CONS_SMC2,
641 CONFIG_8xx_CONS_SCC1, ...), or switch off the serial
642 console by defining CONFIG_8xx_CONS_NONE
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000643
644 Note: if CONFIG_8xx_CONS_NONE is defined, the serial
645 port routines must be defined elsewhere
646 (i.e. serial_init(), serial_getc(), ...)
647
648 CONFIG_CFB_CONSOLE
649 Enables console device for a color framebuffer. Needs following
Wolfgang Denkc53043b2011-12-07 12:19:20 +0000650 defines (cf. smiLynxEM, i8042)
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000651 VIDEO_FB_LITTLE_ENDIAN graphic memory organisation
652 (default big endian)
653 VIDEO_HW_RECTFILL graphic chip supports
654 rectangle fill
655 (cf. smiLynxEM)
656 VIDEO_HW_BITBLT graphic chip supports
657 bit-blit (cf. smiLynxEM)
658 VIDEO_VISIBLE_COLS visible pixel columns
659 (cols=pitch)
wdenkba56f622004-02-06 23:19:44 +0000660 VIDEO_VISIBLE_ROWS visible pixel rows
661 VIDEO_PIXEL_SIZE bytes per pixel
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000662 VIDEO_DATA_FORMAT graphic data format
663 (0-5, cf. cfb_console.c)
wdenkba56f622004-02-06 23:19:44 +0000664 VIDEO_FB_ADRS framebuffer address
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000665 VIDEO_KBD_INIT_FCT keyboard int fct
666 (i.e. i8042_kbd_init())
667 VIDEO_TSTC_FCT test char fct
668 (i.e. i8042_tstc)
669 VIDEO_GETC_FCT get char fct
670 (i.e. i8042_getc)
671 CONFIG_CONSOLE_CURSOR cursor drawing on/off
672 (requires blink timer
673 cf. i8042.c)
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +0200674 CONFIG_SYS_CONSOLE_BLINK_COUNT blink interval (cf. i8042.c)
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000675 CONFIG_CONSOLE_TIME display time/date info in
676 upper right corner
Jon Loeliger602ad3b2007-06-11 19:03:39 -0500677 (requires CONFIG_CMD_DATE)
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000678 CONFIG_VIDEO_LOGO display Linux logo in
679 upper left corner
wdenka6c7ad22002-12-03 21:28:10 +0000680 CONFIG_VIDEO_BMP_LOGO use bmp_logo.h instead of
681 linux_logo.h for logo.
682 Requires CONFIG_VIDEO_LOGO
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000683 CONFIG_CONSOLE_EXTRA_INFO
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +0200684 additional board info beside
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000685 the logo
686
Pali Rohár33a35bb2012-10-19 13:30:09 +0000687 When CONFIG_CFB_CONSOLE_ANSI is defined, console will support
688 a limited number of ANSI escape sequences (cursor control,
689 erase functions and limited graphics rendition control).
690
wdenk43d96162003-03-06 00:02:04 +0000691 When CONFIG_CFB_CONSOLE is defined, video console is
692 default i/o. Serial console can be forced with
693 environment 'console=serial'.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000694
wdenkd4ca31c2004-01-02 14:00:00 +0000695 When CONFIG_SILENT_CONSOLE is defined, all console
696 messages (by U-Boot and Linux!) can be silenced with
697 the "silent" environment variable. See
698 doc/README.silent for more information.
wdenka3ad8e22003-10-19 23:22:11 +0000699
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000700- Console Baudrate:
701 CONFIG_BAUDRATE - in bps
702 Select one of the baudrates listed in
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +0200703 CONFIG_SYS_BAUDRATE_TABLE, see below.
704 CONFIG_SYS_BRGCLK_PRESCALE, baudrate prescale
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000705
Heiko Schocherc92fac92009-01-30 12:55:38 +0100706- Console Rx buffer length
707 With CONFIG_SYS_SMC_RXBUFLEN it is possible to define
708 the maximum receive buffer length for the SMC.
Heiko Schocher2b3f12c2009-02-10 09:31:47 +0100709 This option is actual only for 82xx and 8xx possible.
Heiko Schocherc92fac92009-01-30 12:55:38 +0100710 If using CONFIG_SYS_SMC_RXBUFLEN also CONFIG_SYS_MAXIDLE
711 must be defined, to setup the maximum idle timeout for
712 the SMC.
713
Graeme Russ9558b482011-09-01 00:48:27 +0000714- Pre-Console Buffer:
Wolfgang Denk4cf26092011-10-07 09:58:21 +0200715 Prior to the console being initialised (i.e. serial UART
716 initialised etc) all console output is silently discarded.
717 Defining CONFIG_PRE_CONSOLE_BUFFER will cause U-Boot to
718 buffer any console messages prior to the console being
719 initialised to a buffer of size CONFIG_PRE_CON_BUF_SZ
720 bytes located at CONFIG_PRE_CON_BUF_ADDR. The buffer is
721 a circular buffer, so if more than CONFIG_PRE_CON_BUF_SZ
Wolfgang Denk6feff892011-10-09 21:06:34 +0200722 bytes are output before the console is initialised, the
Wolfgang Denk4cf26092011-10-07 09:58:21 +0200723 earlier bytes are discarded.
Graeme Russ9558b482011-09-01 00:48:27 +0000724
Wolfgang Denk4cf26092011-10-07 09:58:21 +0200725 'Sane' compilers will generate smaller code if
726 CONFIG_PRE_CON_BUF_SZ is a power of 2
Graeme Russ9558b482011-09-01 00:48:27 +0000727
Sonny Rao046a37b2011-11-02 09:52:08 +0000728- Safe printf() functions
729 Define CONFIG_SYS_VSNPRINTF to compile in safe versions of
730 the printf() functions. These are defined in
731 include/vsprintf.h and include snprintf(), vsnprintf() and
732 so on. Code size increase is approximately 300-500 bytes.
733 If this option is not given then these functions will
734 silently discard their buffer size argument - this means
735 you are not getting any overflow checking in this case.
736
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000737- Boot Delay: CONFIG_BOOTDELAY - in seconds
738 Delay before automatically booting the default image;
739 set to -1 to disable autoboot.
Joe Hershberger93d72122012-08-17 10:53:12 +0000740 set to -2 to autoboot with no delay and not check for abort
741 (even when CONFIG_ZERO_BOOTDELAY_CHECK is defined).
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000742
743 See doc/README.autoboot for these options that
744 work with CONFIG_BOOTDELAY. None are required.
745 CONFIG_BOOT_RETRY_TIME
746 CONFIG_BOOT_RETRY_MIN
747 CONFIG_AUTOBOOT_KEYED
748 CONFIG_AUTOBOOT_PROMPT
749 CONFIG_AUTOBOOT_DELAY_STR
750 CONFIG_AUTOBOOT_STOP_STR
751 CONFIG_AUTOBOOT_DELAY_STR2
752 CONFIG_AUTOBOOT_STOP_STR2
753 CONFIG_ZERO_BOOTDELAY_CHECK
754 CONFIG_RESET_TO_RETRY
755
756- Autoboot Command:
757 CONFIG_BOOTCOMMAND
758 Only needed when CONFIG_BOOTDELAY is enabled;
759 define a command string that is automatically executed
760 when no character is read on the console interface
761 within "Boot Delay" after reset.
762
763 CONFIG_BOOTARGS
wdenk43d96162003-03-06 00:02:04 +0000764 This can be used to pass arguments to the bootm
765 command. The value of CONFIG_BOOTARGS goes into the
766 environment value "bootargs".
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000767
768 CONFIG_RAMBOOT and CONFIG_NFSBOOT
wdenk43d96162003-03-06 00:02:04 +0000769 The value of these goes into the environment as
770 "ramboot" and "nfsboot" respectively, and can be used
771 as a convenience, when switching between booting from
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +0200772 RAM and NFS.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000773
774- Pre-Boot Commands:
775 CONFIG_PREBOOT
776
777 When this option is #defined, the existence of the
778 environment variable "preboot" will be checked
779 immediately before starting the CONFIG_BOOTDELAY
780 countdown and/or running the auto-boot command resp.
781 entering interactive mode.
782
783 This feature is especially useful when "preboot" is
784 automatically generated or modified. For an example
785 see the LWMON board specific code: here "preboot" is
786 modified when the user holds down a certain
787 combination of keys on the (special) keyboard when
788 booting the systems
789
790- Serial Download Echo Mode:
791 CONFIG_LOADS_ECHO
792 If defined to 1, all characters received during a
793 serial download (using the "loads" command) are
794 echoed back. This might be needed by some terminal
795 emulations (like "cu"), but may as well just take
796 time on others. This setting #define's the initial
797 value of the "loads_echo" environment variable.
798
Jon Loeliger602ad3b2007-06-11 19:03:39 -0500799- Kgdb Serial Baudrate: (if CONFIG_CMD_KGDB is defined)
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000800 CONFIG_KGDB_BAUDRATE
801 Select one of the baudrates listed in
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +0200802 CONFIG_SYS_BAUDRATE_TABLE, see below.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000803
804- Monitor Functions:
Jon Loeliger602ad3b2007-06-11 19:03:39 -0500805 Monitor commands can be included or excluded
806 from the build by using the #include files
Stephen Warrenc6c621b2012-08-05 16:07:19 +0000807 <config_cmd_all.h> and #undef'ing unwanted
808 commands, or using <config_cmd_default.h>
Jon Loeliger602ad3b2007-06-11 19:03:39 -0500809 and augmenting with additional #define's
810 for wanted commands.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000811
Jon Loeliger602ad3b2007-06-11 19:03:39 -0500812 The default command configuration includes all commands
813 except those marked below with a "*".
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000814
Jon Loeliger602ad3b2007-06-11 19:03:39 -0500815 CONFIG_CMD_ASKENV * ask for env variable
Jon Loeliger602ad3b2007-06-11 19:03:39 -0500816 CONFIG_CMD_BDI bdinfo
817 CONFIG_CMD_BEDBUG * Include BedBug Debugger
818 CONFIG_CMD_BMP * BMP support
819 CONFIG_CMD_BSP * Board specific commands
820 CONFIG_CMD_BOOTD bootd
821 CONFIG_CMD_CACHE * icache, dcache
822 CONFIG_CMD_CONSOLE coninfo
Mike Frysinger710b9932010-12-21 14:19:51 -0500823 CONFIG_CMD_CRC32 * crc32
Jon Loeliger602ad3b2007-06-11 19:03:39 -0500824 CONFIG_CMD_DATE * support for RTC, date/time...
825 CONFIG_CMD_DHCP * DHCP support
826 CONFIG_CMD_DIAG * Diagnostics
Peter Tysera7c93102008-12-17 16:36:22 -0600827 CONFIG_CMD_DS4510 * ds4510 I2C gpio commands
828 CONFIG_CMD_DS4510_INFO * ds4510 I2C info command
829 CONFIG_CMD_DS4510_MEM * ds4510 I2C eeprom/sram commansd
830 CONFIG_CMD_DS4510_RST * ds4510 I2C rst command
Jon Loeliger602ad3b2007-06-11 19:03:39 -0500831 CONFIG_CMD_DTT * Digital Therm and Thermostat
832 CONFIG_CMD_ECHO echo arguments
Peter Tyser246c6922009-10-25 15:12:56 -0500833 CONFIG_CMD_EDITENV edit env variable
Jon Loeliger602ad3b2007-06-11 19:03:39 -0500834 CONFIG_CMD_EEPROM * EEPROM read/write support
835 CONFIG_CMD_ELF * bootelf, bootvx
Joe Hershberger5e2b3e02012-12-11 22:16:25 -0600836 CONFIG_CMD_ENV_CALLBACK * display details about env callbacks
Joe Hershbergerfffad712012-12-11 22:16:33 -0600837 CONFIG_CMD_ENV_FLAGS * display details about env flags
Mike Frysinger0c79cda2010-12-26 23:09:45 -0500838 CONFIG_CMD_EXPORTENV * export the environment
Stephen Warren03e2ecf2012-10-22 06:43:50 +0000839 CONFIG_CMD_EXT2 * ext2 command support
840 CONFIG_CMD_EXT4 * ext4 command support
Mike Frysingerbdab39d2009-01-28 19:08:14 -0500841 CONFIG_CMD_SAVEENV saveenv
Jon Loeliger602ad3b2007-06-11 19:03:39 -0500842 CONFIG_CMD_FDC * Floppy Disk Support
Stephen Warren03e2ecf2012-10-22 06:43:50 +0000843 CONFIG_CMD_FAT * FAT command support
Jon Loeliger602ad3b2007-06-11 19:03:39 -0500844 CONFIG_CMD_FDOS * Dos diskette Support
845 CONFIG_CMD_FLASH flinfo, erase, protect
846 CONFIG_CMD_FPGA FPGA device initialization support
Anton Staaf53fdc7e2012-12-05 14:46:29 +0000847 CONFIG_CMD_GETTIME * Get time since boot
Mike Frysingera641b972010-12-26 23:32:22 -0500848 CONFIG_CMD_GO * the 'go' command (exec code)
Kim Phillipsa000b792011-04-05 07:15:14 +0000849 CONFIG_CMD_GREPENV * search environment
Simon Glassbf36c5d2012-12-05 14:46:38 +0000850 CONFIG_CMD_HASH * calculate hash / digest
Jon Loeliger602ad3b2007-06-11 19:03:39 -0500851 CONFIG_CMD_HWFLOW * RTS/CTS hw flow control
852 CONFIG_CMD_I2C * I2C serial bus support
853 CONFIG_CMD_IDE * IDE harddisk support
854 CONFIG_CMD_IMI iminfo
Vipin Kumar8fdf1e02012-12-16 22:32:48 +0000855 CONFIG_CMD_IMLS List all images found in NOR flash
856 CONFIG_CMD_IMLS_NAND List all images found in NAND flash
Jon Loeliger602ad3b2007-06-11 19:03:39 -0500857 CONFIG_CMD_IMMAP * IMMR dump support
Mike Frysinger0c79cda2010-12-26 23:09:45 -0500858 CONFIG_CMD_IMPORTENV * import an environment
Joe Hershbergerc167cc02012-10-03 11:15:51 +0000859 CONFIG_CMD_INI * import data from an ini file into the env
Jon Loeliger602ad3b2007-06-11 19:03:39 -0500860 CONFIG_CMD_IRQ * irqinfo
861 CONFIG_CMD_ITEST Integer/string test of 2 values
862 CONFIG_CMD_JFFS2 * JFFS2 Support
863 CONFIG_CMD_KGDB * kgdb
Mike Frysinger1ba7fd22010-12-26 12:34:49 -0500864 CONFIG_CMD_LDRINFO ldrinfo (display Blackfin loader)
Joe Hershbergerd22c3382012-05-23 08:00:12 +0000865 CONFIG_CMD_LINK_LOCAL * link-local IP address auto-configuration
866 (169.254.*.*)
Jon Loeliger602ad3b2007-06-11 19:03:39 -0500867 CONFIG_CMD_LOADB loadb
868 CONFIG_CMD_LOADS loads
Robin Getz02c9aa12009-07-27 00:07:59 -0400869 CONFIG_CMD_MD5SUM print md5 message digest
870 (requires CONFIG_CMD_MEMORY and CONFIG_MD5)
Simon Glass15a33e42012-11-30 13:01:20 +0000871 CONFIG_CMD_MEMINFO * Display detailed memory information
Jon Loeliger602ad3b2007-06-11 19:03:39 -0500872 CONFIG_CMD_MEMORY md, mm, nm, mw, cp, cmp, crc, base,
Wolfgang Denka2681702013-03-08 10:51:32 +0000873 loop, loopw
874 CONFIG_CMD_MEMTEST mtest
Jon Loeliger602ad3b2007-06-11 19:03:39 -0500875 CONFIG_CMD_MISC Misc functions like sleep etc
876 CONFIG_CMD_MMC * MMC memory mapped support
877 CONFIG_CMD_MII * MII utility commands
Stefan Roese68d7d652009-03-19 13:30:36 +0100878 CONFIG_CMD_MTDPARTS * MTD partition support
Jon Loeliger602ad3b2007-06-11 19:03:39 -0500879 CONFIG_CMD_NAND * NAND support
880 CONFIG_CMD_NET bootp, tftpboot, rarpboot
Peter Tysere92739d2008-12-17 16:36:21 -0600881 CONFIG_CMD_PCA953X * PCA953x I2C gpio commands
Wolfgang Denkc0f40852011-10-26 10:21:21 +0000882 CONFIG_CMD_PCA953X_INFO * PCA953x I2C gpio info command
Jon Loeliger602ad3b2007-06-11 19:03:39 -0500883 CONFIG_CMD_PCI * pciinfo
884 CONFIG_CMD_PCMCIA * PCMCIA support
885 CONFIG_CMD_PING * send ICMP ECHO_REQUEST to network
886 host
887 CONFIG_CMD_PORTIO * Port I/O
Kenneth Watersff048ea2012-12-05 14:46:30 +0000888 CONFIG_CMD_READ * Read raw data from partition
Jon Loeliger602ad3b2007-06-11 19:03:39 -0500889 CONFIG_CMD_REGINFO * Register dump
890 CONFIG_CMD_RUN run command in env variable
Simon Glassd3049312012-12-26 09:53:36 +0000891 CONFIG_CMD_SANDBOX * sb command to access sandbox features
Jon Loeliger602ad3b2007-06-11 19:03:39 -0500892 CONFIG_CMD_SAVES * save S record dump
893 CONFIG_CMD_SCSI * SCSI Support
894 CONFIG_CMD_SDRAM * print SDRAM configuration information
895 (requires CONFIG_CMD_I2C)
896 CONFIG_CMD_SETGETDCR Support for DCR Register access
897 (4xx only)
Eric Nelsonf61ec452012-01-31 10:52:08 -0700898 CONFIG_CMD_SF * Read/write/erase SPI NOR flash
Alexander Hollerc6b1ee62011-01-18 09:48:08 +0100899 CONFIG_CMD_SHA1SUM print sha1 memory digest
Robin Getz02c9aa12009-07-27 00:07:59 -0400900 (requires CONFIG_CMD_MEMORY)
Wolfgang Denk74de7ae2009-04-01 23:34:12 +0200901 CONFIG_CMD_SOURCE "source" command Support
Jon Loeliger602ad3b2007-06-11 19:03:39 -0500902 CONFIG_CMD_SPI * SPI serial bus support
Luca Ceresoli7a83af02011-05-17 00:03:40 +0000903 CONFIG_CMD_TFTPSRV * TFTP transfer in server mode
Simon Glass1fb7cd42011-10-24 18:00:07 +0000904 CONFIG_CMD_TFTPPUT * TFTP put command (upload)
Joe Hershbergerda83bcd2012-10-03 12:14:57 +0000905 CONFIG_CMD_TIME * run command and report execution time (ARM specific)
906 CONFIG_CMD_TIMER * access to the system tick timer
Jon Loeliger602ad3b2007-06-11 19:03:39 -0500907 CONFIG_CMD_USB * USB support
Jon Loeliger602ad3b2007-06-11 19:03:39 -0500908 CONFIG_CMD_CDP * Cisco Discover Protocol support
Marek Vasutc8339f52012-03-31 07:47:16 +0000909 CONFIG_CMD_MFSL * Microblaze FSL support
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000910
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000911
912 EXAMPLE: If you want all functions except of network
913 support you can write:
914
Jon Loeliger602ad3b2007-06-11 19:03:39 -0500915 #include "config_cmd_all.h"
916 #undef CONFIG_CMD_NET
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000917
Gerald Van Baren213bf8c2007-03-31 12:23:51 -0400918 Other Commands:
919 fdt (flattened device tree) command: CONFIG_OF_LIBFDT
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000920
921 Note: Don't enable the "icache" and "dcache" commands
Jon Loeliger602ad3b2007-06-11 19:03:39 -0500922 (configuration option CONFIG_CMD_CACHE) unless you know
wdenk43d96162003-03-06 00:02:04 +0000923 what you (and your U-Boot users) are doing. Data
924 cache cannot be enabled on systems like the 8xx or
925 8260 (where accesses to the IMMR region must be
926 uncached), and it cannot be disabled on all other
927 systems where we (mis-) use the data cache to hold an
928 initial stack and some data.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000929
930
931 XXX - this list needs to get updated!
932
Simon Glass45ba8072011-10-15 05:48:20 +0000933- Device tree:
934 CONFIG_OF_CONTROL
935 If this variable is defined, U-Boot will use a device tree
936 to configure its devices, instead of relying on statically
937 compiled #defines in the board file. This option is
938 experimental and only available on a few boards. The device
939 tree is available in the global data as gd->fdt_blob.
940
Simon Glass2c0f79e2011-10-24 19:15:31 +0000941 U-Boot needs to get its device tree from somewhere. This can
942 be done using one of the two options below:
Simon Glassbbb0b122011-10-15 05:48:21 +0000943
944 CONFIG_OF_EMBED
945 If this variable is defined, U-Boot will embed a device tree
946 binary in its image. This device tree file should be in the
947 board directory and called <soc>-<board>.dts. The binary file
948 is then picked up in board_init_f() and made available through
949 the global data structure as gd->blob.
Simon Glass45ba8072011-10-15 05:48:20 +0000950
Simon Glass2c0f79e2011-10-24 19:15:31 +0000951 CONFIG_OF_SEPARATE
952 If this variable is defined, U-Boot will build a device tree
953 binary. It will be called u-boot.dtb. Architecture-specific
954 code will locate it at run-time. Generally this works by:
955
956 cat u-boot.bin u-boot.dtb >image.bin
957
958 and in fact, U-Boot does this for you, creating a file called
959 u-boot-dtb.bin which is useful in the common case. You can
960 still use the individual files if you need something more
961 exotic.
962
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000963- Watchdog:
964 CONFIG_WATCHDOG
965 If this variable is defined, it enables watchdog
Detlev Zundel6abe6fb2011-04-27 05:25:59 +0000966 support for the SoC. There must be support in the SoC
967 specific code for a watchdog. For the 8xx and 8260
968 CPUs, the SIU Watchdog feature is enabled in the SYPCR
969 register. When supported for a specific SoC is
970 available, then no further board specific code should
971 be needed to use it.
972
973 CONFIG_HW_WATCHDOG
974 When using a watchdog circuitry external to the used
975 SoC, then define this variable and provide board
976 specific code for the "hw_watchdog_reset" function.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000977
stroesec1551ea2003-04-04 15:53:41 +0000978- U-Boot Version:
979 CONFIG_VERSION_VARIABLE
980 If this variable is defined, an environment variable
981 named "ver" is created by U-Boot showing the U-Boot
982 version as printed by the "version" command.
Benoît Thébaudeaua1ea8e52012-08-13 15:01:14 +0200983 Any change to this variable will be reverted at the
984 next reset.
stroesec1551ea2003-04-04 15:53:41 +0000985
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000986- Real-Time Clock:
987
Jon Loeliger602ad3b2007-06-11 19:03:39 -0500988 When CONFIG_CMD_DATE is selected, the type of the RTC
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000989 has to be selected, too. Define exactly one of the
990 following options:
991
992 CONFIG_RTC_MPC8xx - use internal RTC of MPC8xx
993 CONFIG_RTC_PCF8563 - use Philips PCF8563 RTC
Fabio Estevam4e8b7542011-10-24 06:44:15 +0000994 CONFIG_RTC_MC13XXX - use MC13783 or MC13892 RTC
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000995 CONFIG_RTC_MC146818 - use MC146818 RTC
wdenk1cb8e982003-03-06 21:55:29 +0000996 CONFIG_RTC_DS1307 - use Maxim, Inc. DS1307 RTC
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +0000997 CONFIG_RTC_DS1337 - use Maxim, Inc. DS1337 RTC
wdenk7f70e852003-05-20 14:25:27 +0000998 CONFIG_RTC_DS1338 - use Maxim, Inc. DS1338 RTC
wdenk3bac3512003-03-12 10:41:04 +0000999 CONFIG_RTC_DS164x - use Dallas DS164x RTC
Tor Krill9536dfc2008-03-15 15:40:26 +01001000 CONFIG_RTC_ISL1208 - use Intersil ISL1208 RTC
wdenk4c0d4c32004-06-09 17:34:58 +00001001 CONFIG_RTC_MAX6900 - use Maxim, Inc. MAX6900 RTC
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02001002 CONFIG_SYS_RTC_DS1337_NOOSC - Turn off the OSC output for DS1337
Heiko Schocher71d19f32011-03-28 09:24:22 +02001003 CONFIG_SYS_RV3029_TCR - enable trickle charger on
1004 RV3029 RTC.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001005
wdenkb37c7e52003-06-30 16:24:52 +00001006 Note that if the RTC uses I2C, then the I2C interface
1007 must also be configured. See I2C Support, below.
1008
Peter Tysere92739d2008-12-17 16:36:21 -06001009- GPIO Support:
1010 CONFIG_PCA953X - use NXP's PCA953X series I2C GPIO
1011 CONFIG_PCA953X_INFO - enable pca953x info command
1012
Chris Packham5dec49c2010-12-19 10:12:13 +00001013 The CONFIG_SYS_I2C_PCA953X_WIDTH option specifies a list of
1014 chip-ngpio pairs that tell the PCA953X driver the number of
1015 pins supported by a particular chip.
1016
Peter Tysere92739d2008-12-17 16:36:21 -06001017 Note that if the GPIO device uses I2C, then the I2C interface
1018 must also be configured. See I2C Support, below.
1019
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001020- Timestamp Support:
1021
wdenk43d96162003-03-06 00:02:04 +00001022 When CONFIG_TIMESTAMP is selected, the timestamp
1023 (date and time) of an image is printed by image
1024 commands like bootm or iminfo. This option is
Jon Loeliger602ad3b2007-06-11 19:03:39 -05001025 automatically enabled when you select CONFIG_CMD_DATE .
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001026
Karl O. Pinc923c46f2012-08-16 06:20:15 +00001027- Partition Labels (disklabels) Supported:
1028 Zero or more of the following:
1029 CONFIG_MAC_PARTITION Apple's MacOS partition table.
1030 CONFIG_DOS_PARTITION MS Dos partition table, traditional on the
1031 Intel architecture, USB sticks, etc.
1032 CONFIG_ISO_PARTITION ISO partition table, used on CDROM etc.
1033 CONFIG_EFI_PARTITION GPT partition table, common when EFI is the
1034 bootloader. Note 2TB partition limit; see
1035 disk/part_efi.c
1036 CONFIG_MTD_PARTITIONS Memory Technology Device partition table.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001037
Wolfgang Denk218ca722008-03-26 10:40:12 +01001038 If IDE or SCSI support is enabled (CONFIG_CMD_IDE or
1039 CONFIG_CMD_SCSI) you must configure support for at
Karl O. Pinc923c46f2012-08-16 06:20:15 +00001040 least one non-MTD partition type as well.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001041
1042- IDE Reset method:
wdenk4d13cba2004-03-14 14:09:05 +00001043 CONFIG_IDE_RESET_ROUTINE - this is defined in several
1044 board configurations files but used nowhere!
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001045
wdenk4d13cba2004-03-14 14:09:05 +00001046 CONFIG_IDE_RESET - is this is defined, IDE Reset will
1047 be performed by calling the function
1048 ide_set_reset(int reset)
1049 which has to be defined in a board specific file
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001050
1051- ATAPI Support:
1052 CONFIG_ATAPI
1053
1054 Set this to enable ATAPI support.
1055
wdenkc40b2952004-03-13 23:29:43 +00001056- LBA48 Support
1057 CONFIG_LBA48
1058
1059 Set this to enable support for disks larger than 137GB
Heiko Schocher4b142fe2009-12-03 11:21:21 +01001060 Also look at CONFIG_SYS_64BIT_LBA.
wdenkc40b2952004-03-13 23:29:43 +00001061 Whithout these , LBA48 support uses 32bit variables and will 'only'
1062 support disks up to 2.1TB.
1063
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02001064 CONFIG_SYS_64BIT_LBA:
wdenkc40b2952004-03-13 23:29:43 +00001065 When enabled, makes the IDE subsystem use 64bit sector addresses.
1066 Default is 32bit.
1067
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001068- SCSI Support:
1069 At the moment only there is only support for the
1070 SYM53C8XX SCSI controller; define
1071 CONFIG_SCSI_SYM53C8XX to enable it.
1072
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02001073 CONFIG_SYS_SCSI_MAX_LUN [8], CONFIG_SYS_SCSI_MAX_SCSI_ID [7] and
1074 CONFIG_SYS_SCSI_MAX_DEVICE [CONFIG_SYS_SCSI_MAX_SCSI_ID *
1075 CONFIG_SYS_SCSI_MAX_LUN] can be adjusted to define the
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001076 maximum numbers of LUNs, SCSI ID's and target
1077 devices.
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02001078 CONFIG_SYS_SCSI_SYM53C8XX_CCF to fix clock timing (80Mhz)
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001079
Stefan Reinauer447c0312012-10-29 05:23:48 +00001080 The environment variable 'scsidevs' is set to the number of
1081 SCSI devices found during the last scan.
1082
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001083- NETWORK Support (PCI):
wdenk682011f2003-06-03 23:54:09 +00001084 CONFIG_E1000
Kyle Moffettce5207e2011-10-18 11:05:29 +00001085 Support for Intel 8254x/8257x gigabit chips.
1086
1087 CONFIG_E1000_SPI
1088 Utility code for direct access to the SPI bus on Intel 8257x.
1089 This does not do anything useful unless you set at least one
1090 of CONFIG_CMD_E1000 or CONFIG_E1000_SPI_GENERIC.
1091
1092 CONFIG_E1000_SPI_GENERIC
1093 Allow generic access to the SPI bus on the Intel 8257x, for
1094 example with the "sspi" command.
1095
1096 CONFIG_CMD_E1000
1097 Management command for E1000 devices. When used on devices
1098 with SPI support you can reprogram the EEPROM from U-Boot.
stroese53cf9432003-06-05 15:39:44 +00001099
Andre Schwarzac3315c2008-03-06 16:45:44 +01001100 CONFIG_E1000_FALLBACK_MAC
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02001101 default MAC for empty EEPROM after production.
Andre Schwarzac3315c2008-03-06 16:45:44 +01001102
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001103 CONFIG_EEPRO100
1104 Support for Intel 82557/82559/82559ER chips.
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02001105 Optional CONFIG_EEPRO100_SROM_WRITE enables EEPROM
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001106 write routine for first time initialisation.
1107
1108 CONFIG_TULIP
1109 Support for Digital 2114x chips.
1110 Optional CONFIG_TULIP_SELECT_MEDIA for board specific
1111 modem chip initialisation (KS8761/QS6611).
1112
1113 CONFIG_NATSEMI
1114 Support for National dp83815 chips.
1115
1116 CONFIG_NS8382X
1117 Support for National dp8382[01] gigabit chips.
1118
wdenk45219c42003-05-12 21:50:16 +00001119- NETWORK Support (other):
1120
Jens Scharsigc041e9d2010-01-23 12:03:45 +01001121 CONFIG_DRIVER_AT91EMAC
1122 Support for AT91RM9200 EMAC.
1123
1124 CONFIG_RMII
1125 Define this to use reduced MII inteface
1126
1127 CONFIG_DRIVER_AT91EMAC_QUIET
1128 If this defined, the driver is quiet.
1129 The driver doen't show link status messages.
1130
Rob Herringefdd7312011-12-15 11:15:49 +00001131 CONFIG_CALXEDA_XGMAC
1132 Support for the Calxeda XGMAC device
1133
Ashok3bb46d22012-10-15 06:20:47 +00001134 CONFIG_LAN91C96
wdenk45219c42003-05-12 21:50:16 +00001135 Support for SMSC's LAN91C96 chips.
1136
1137 CONFIG_LAN91C96_BASE
1138 Define this to hold the physical address
1139 of the LAN91C96's I/O space
1140
1141 CONFIG_LAN91C96_USE_32_BIT
1142 Define this to enable 32 bit addressing
1143
Ashok3bb46d22012-10-15 06:20:47 +00001144 CONFIG_SMC91111
wdenkf39748a2004-06-09 13:37:52 +00001145 Support for SMSC's LAN91C111 chip
1146
1147 CONFIG_SMC91111_BASE
1148 Define this to hold the physical address
1149 of the device (I/O space)
1150
1151 CONFIG_SMC_USE_32_BIT
1152 Define this if data bus is 32 bits
1153
1154 CONFIG_SMC_USE_IOFUNCS
1155 Define this to use i/o functions instead of macros
1156 (some hardware wont work with macros)
1157
Heiko Schocherdc02bad2011-11-15 10:00:04 -05001158 CONFIG_DRIVER_TI_EMAC
1159 Support for davinci emac
1160
1161 CONFIG_SYS_DAVINCI_EMAC_PHY_COUNT
1162 Define this if you have more then 3 PHYs.
1163
Macpaul Linb3dbf4a52010-12-21 16:59:46 +08001164 CONFIG_FTGMAC100
1165 Support for Faraday's FTGMAC100 Gigabit SoC Ethernet
1166
1167 CONFIG_FTGMAC100_EGIGA
1168 Define this to use GE link update with gigabit PHY.
1169 Define this if FTGMAC100 is connected to gigabit PHY.
1170 If your system has 10/100 PHY only, it might not occur
1171 wrong behavior. Because PHY usually return timeout or
1172 useless data when polling gigabit status and gigabit
1173 control registers. This behavior won't affect the
1174 correctnessof 10/100 link speed update.
1175
Mike Rapoportc2fff332009-11-11 10:03:03 +02001176 CONFIG_SMC911X
Jens Gehrlein557b3772008-05-05 14:06:11 +02001177 Support for SMSC's LAN911x and LAN921x chips
1178
Mike Rapoportc2fff332009-11-11 10:03:03 +02001179 CONFIG_SMC911X_BASE
Jens Gehrlein557b3772008-05-05 14:06:11 +02001180 Define this to hold the physical address
1181 of the device (I/O space)
1182
Mike Rapoportc2fff332009-11-11 10:03:03 +02001183 CONFIG_SMC911X_32_BIT
Jens Gehrlein557b3772008-05-05 14:06:11 +02001184 Define this if data bus is 32 bits
1185
Mike Rapoportc2fff332009-11-11 10:03:03 +02001186 CONFIG_SMC911X_16_BIT
Jens Gehrlein557b3772008-05-05 14:06:11 +02001187 Define this if data bus is 16 bits. If your processor
1188 automatically converts one 32 bit word to two 16 bit
Mike Rapoportc2fff332009-11-11 10:03:03 +02001189 words you may also try CONFIG_SMC911X_32_BIT.
Jens Gehrlein557b3772008-05-05 14:06:11 +02001190
Yoshihiro Shimoda3d0075f2011-01-27 10:06:03 +09001191 CONFIG_SH_ETHER
1192 Support for Renesas on-chip Ethernet controller
1193
1194 CONFIG_SH_ETHER_USE_PORT
1195 Define the number of ports to be used
1196
1197 CONFIG_SH_ETHER_PHY_ADDR
1198 Define the ETH PHY's address
1199
Yoshihiro Shimoda68260aa2011-01-27 10:06:08 +09001200 CONFIG_SH_ETHER_CACHE_WRITEBACK
1201 If this option is set, the driver enables cache flush.
1202
Vadim Bendebury5e124722011-10-17 08:36:14 +00001203- TPM Support:
1204 CONFIG_GENERIC_LPC_TPM
1205 Support for generic parallel port TPM devices. Only one device
1206 per system is supported at this time.
1207
1208 CONFIG_TPM_TIS_BASE_ADDRESS
1209 Base address where the generic TPM device is mapped
1210 to. Contemporary x86 systems usually map it at
1211 0xfed40000.
1212
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001213- USB Support:
1214 At the moment only the UHCI host controller is
wdenk4d13cba2004-03-14 14:09:05 +00001215 supported (PIP405, MIP405, MPC5200); define
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001216 CONFIG_USB_UHCI to enable it.
1217 define CONFIG_USB_KEYBOARD to enable the USB Keyboard
wdenk30d56fa2004-10-09 22:44:59 +00001218 and define CONFIG_USB_STORAGE to enable the USB
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001219 storage devices.
1220 Note:
1221 Supported are USB Keyboards and USB Floppy drives
1222 (TEAC FD-05PUB).
wdenk4d13cba2004-03-14 14:09:05 +00001223 MPC5200 USB requires additional defines:
1224 CONFIG_USB_CLOCK
1225 for 528 MHz Clock: 0x0001bbbb
Eric Millbrandt307ecb62009-08-13 08:32:37 -05001226 CONFIG_PSC3_USB
1227 for USB on PSC3
wdenk4d13cba2004-03-14 14:09:05 +00001228 CONFIG_USB_CONFIG
1229 for differential drivers: 0x00001000
1230 for single ended drivers: 0x00005000
Eric Millbrandt307ecb62009-08-13 08:32:37 -05001231 for differential drivers on PSC3: 0x00000100
1232 for single ended drivers on PSC3: 0x00004100
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02001233 CONFIG_SYS_USB_EVENT_POLL
Zhang Weifdcfaa12007-06-06 10:08:13 +02001234 May be defined to allow interrupt polling
1235 instead of using asynchronous interrupts
wdenk4d13cba2004-03-14 14:09:05 +00001236
Simon Glass9ab4ce22012-02-27 10:52:47 +00001237 CONFIG_USB_EHCI_TXFIFO_THRESH enables setting of the
1238 txfilltuning field in the EHCI controller on reset.
1239
Wolfgang Denk16c8d5e2006-06-14 17:45:53 +02001240- USB Device:
1241 Define the below if you wish to use the USB console.
1242 Once firmware is rebuilt from a serial console issue the
1243 command "setenv stdin usbtty; setenv stdout usbtty" and
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02001244 attach your USB cable. The Unix command "dmesg" should print
Wolfgang Denk16c8d5e2006-06-14 17:45:53 +02001245 it has found a new device. The environment variable usbtty
1246 can be set to gserial or cdc_acm to enable your device to
Wolfgang Denk386eda02006-06-14 18:14:56 +02001247 appear to a USB host as a Linux gserial device or a
Wolfgang Denk16c8d5e2006-06-14 17:45:53 +02001248 Common Device Class Abstract Control Model serial device.
1249 If you select usbtty = gserial you should be able to enumerate
1250 a Linux host by
1251 # modprobe usbserial vendor=0xVendorID product=0xProductID
1252 else if using cdc_acm, simply setting the environment
1253 variable usbtty to be cdc_acm should suffice. The following
1254 might be defined in YourBoardName.h
Wolfgang Denk386eda02006-06-14 18:14:56 +02001255
Wolfgang Denk16c8d5e2006-06-14 17:45:53 +02001256 CONFIG_USB_DEVICE
1257 Define this to build a UDC device
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001258
Wolfgang Denk16c8d5e2006-06-14 17:45:53 +02001259 CONFIG_USB_TTY
1260 Define this to have a tty type of device available to
1261 talk to the UDC device
Wolfgang Denk386eda02006-06-14 18:14:56 +02001262
Vipin KUMARf9da0f82012-03-26 15:38:06 +05301263 CONFIG_USBD_HS
1264 Define this to enable the high speed support for usb
1265 device and usbtty. If this feature is enabled, a routine
1266 int is_usbd_high_speed(void)
1267 also needs to be defined by the driver to dynamically poll
1268 whether the enumeration has succeded at high speed or full
1269 speed.
1270
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02001271 CONFIG_SYS_CONSOLE_IS_IN_ENV
Wolfgang Denk16c8d5e2006-06-14 17:45:53 +02001272 Define this if you want stdin, stdout &/or stderr to
1273 be set to usbtty.
1274
1275 mpc8xx:
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02001276 CONFIG_SYS_USB_EXTC_CLK 0xBLAH
Wolfgang Denk16c8d5e2006-06-14 17:45:53 +02001277 Derive USB clock from external clock "blah"
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02001278 - CONFIG_SYS_USB_EXTC_CLK 0x02
Wolfgang Denk386eda02006-06-14 18:14:56 +02001279
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02001280 CONFIG_SYS_USB_BRG_CLK 0xBLAH
Wolfgang Denk16c8d5e2006-06-14 17:45:53 +02001281 Derive USB clock from brgclk
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02001282 - CONFIG_SYS_USB_BRG_CLK 0x04
Wolfgang Denk16c8d5e2006-06-14 17:45:53 +02001283
Wolfgang Denk386eda02006-06-14 18:14:56 +02001284 If you have a USB-IF assigned VendorID then you may wish to
Wolfgang Denk16c8d5e2006-06-14 17:45:53 +02001285 define your own vendor specific values either in BoardName.h
Wolfgang Denk386eda02006-06-14 18:14:56 +02001286 or directly in usbd_vendor_info.h. If you don't define
Wolfgang Denk16c8d5e2006-06-14 17:45:53 +02001287 CONFIG_USBD_MANUFACTURER, CONFIG_USBD_PRODUCT_NAME,
1288 CONFIG_USBD_VENDORID and CONFIG_USBD_PRODUCTID, then U-Boot
1289 should pretend to be a Linux device to it's target host.
1290
1291 CONFIG_USBD_MANUFACTURER
1292 Define this string as the name of your company for
1293 - CONFIG_USBD_MANUFACTURER "my company"
Wolfgang Denk386eda02006-06-14 18:14:56 +02001294
Wolfgang Denk16c8d5e2006-06-14 17:45:53 +02001295 CONFIG_USBD_PRODUCT_NAME
1296 Define this string as the name of your product
1297 - CONFIG_USBD_PRODUCT_NAME "acme usb device"
1298
1299 CONFIG_USBD_VENDORID
1300 Define this as your assigned Vendor ID from the USB
1301 Implementors Forum. This *must* be a genuine Vendor ID
1302 to avoid polluting the USB namespace.
1303 - CONFIG_USBD_VENDORID 0xFFFF
Wolfgang Denk386eda02006-06-14 18:14:56 +02001304
Wolfgang Denk16c8d5e2006-06-14 17:45:53 +02001305 CONFIG_USBD_PRODUCTID
1306 Define this as the unique Product ID
1307 for your device
1308 - CONFIG_USBD_PRODUCTID 0xFFFF
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001309
Igor Grinbergd70a5602011-12-12 12:08:35 +02001310- ULPI Layer Support:
1311 The ULPI (UTMI Low Pin (count) Interface) PHYs are supported via
1312 the generic ULPI layer. The generic layer accesses the ULPI PHY
1313 via the platform viewport, so you need both the genric layer and
1314 the viewport enabled. Currently only Chipidea/ARC based
1315 viewport is supported.
1316 To enable the ULPI layer support, define CONFIG_USB_ULPI and
1317 CONFIG_USB_ULPI_VIEWPORT in your board configuration file.
Lucas Stach6d365ea2012-10-01 00:44:35 +02001318 If your ULPI phy needs a different reference clock than the
1319 standard 24 MHz then you have to define CONFIG_ULPI_REF_CLK to
1320 the appropriate value in Hz.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001321
1322- MMC Support:
1323 The MMC controller on the Intel PXA is supported. To
1324 enable this define CONFIG_MMC. The MMC can be
1325 accessed from the boot prompt by mapping the device
1326 to physical memory similar to flash. Command line is
Jon Loeliger602ad3b2007-06-11 19:03:39 -05001327 enabled with CONFIG_CMD_MMC. The MMC driver also works with
1328 the FAT fs. This is enabled with CONFIG_CMD_FAT.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001329
Yoshihiro Shimodaafb35662011-07-04 22:21:22 +00001330 CONFIG_SH_MMCIF
1331 Support for Renesas on-chip MMCIF controller
1332
1333 CONFIG_SH_MMCIF_ADDR
1334 Define the base address of MMCIF registers
1335
1336 CONFIG_SH_MMCIF_CLK
1337 Define the clock frequency for MMCIF
1338
wdenk6705d812004-08-02 23:22:59 +00001339- Journaling Flash filesystem support:
1340 CONFIG_JFFS2_NAND, CONFIG_JFFS2_NAND_OFF, CONFIG_JFFS2_NAND_SIZE,
1341 CONFIG_JFFS2_NAND_DEV
1342 Define these for a default partition on a NAND device
1343
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02001344 CONFIG_SYS_JFFS2_FIRST_SECTOR,
1345 CONFIG_SYS_JFFS2_FIRST_BANK, CONFIG_SYS_JFFS2_NUM_BANKS
wdenk6705d812004-08-02 23:22:59 +00001346 Define these for a default partition on a NOR device
1347
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02001348 CONFIG_SYS_JFFS_CUSTOM_PART
wdenk6705d812004-08-02 23:22:59 +00001349 Define this to create an own partition. You have to provide a
1350 function struct part_info* jffs2_part_info(int part_num)
1351
1352 If you define only one JFFS2 partition you may also want to
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02001353 #define CONFIG_SYS_JFFS_SINGLE_PART 1
wdenk6705d812004-08-02 23:22:59 +00001354 to disable the command chpart. This is the default when you
1355 have not defined a custom partition
1356
Donggeun Kimc30a15e2011-10-24 21:15:28 +00001357- FAT(File Allocation Table) filesystem write function support:
1358 CONFIG_FAT_WRITE
Donggeun Kim656f4c62012-03-22 04:38:56 +00001359
1360 Define this to enable support for saving memory data as a
1361 file in FAT formatted partition.
1362
1363 This will also enable the command "fatwrite" enabling the
1364 user to write files to FAT.
Donggeun Kimc30a15e2011-10-24 21:15:28 +00001365
Gabe Black84cd9322012-10-12 14:26:11 +00001366CBFS (Coreboot Filesystem) support
1367 CONFIG_CMD_CBFS
1368
1369 Define this to enable support for reading from a Coreboot
1370 filesystem. Available commands are cbfsinit, cbfsinfo, cbfsls
1371 and cbfsload.
1372
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001373- Keyboard Support:
1374 CONFIG_ISA_KEYBOARD
1375
1376 Define this to enable standard (PC-Style) keyboard
1377 support
1378
1379 CONFIG_I8042_KBD
1380 Standard PC keyboard driver with US (is default) and
1381 GERMAN key layout (switch via environment 'keymap=de') support.
1382 Export function i8042_kbd_init, i8042_tstc and i8042_getc
1383 for cfb_console. Supports cursor blinking.
1384
1385- Video support:
1386 CONFIG_VIDEO
1387
1388 Define this to enable video support (for output to
1389 video).
1390
1391 CONFIG_VIDEO_CT69000
1392
1393 Enable Chips & Technologies 69000 Video chip
1394
1395 CONFIG_VIDEO_SMI_LYNXEM
wdenkb79a11c2004-03-25 15:14:43 +00001396 Enable Silicon Motion SMI 712/710/810 Video chip. The
wdenkeeb1b772004-03-23 22:53:55 +00001397 video output is selected via environment 'videoout'
1398 (1 = LCD and 2 = CRT). If videoout is undefined, CRT is
1399 assumed.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001400
wdenkb79a11c2004-03-25 15:14:43 +00001401 For the CT69000 and SMI_LYNXEM drivers, videomode is
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02001402 selected via environment 'videomode'. Two different ways
wdenkeeb1b772004-03-23 22:53:55 +00001403 are possible:
1404 - "videomode=num" 'num' is a standard LiLo mode numbers.
wdenk6e592382004-04-18 17:39:38 +00001405 Following standard modes are supported (* is default):
wdenkeeb1b772004-03-23 22:53:55 +00001406
1407 Colors 640x480 800x600 1024x768 1152x864 1280x1024
1408 -------------+---------------------------------------------
1409 8 bits | 0x301* 0x303 0x305 0x161 0x307
1410 15 bits | 0x310 0x313 0x316 0x162 0x319
1411 16 bits | 0x311 0x314 0x317 0x163 0x31A
1412 24 bits | 0x312 0x315 0x318 ? 0x31B
1413 -------------+---------------------------------------------
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001414 (i.e. setenv videomode 317; saveenv; reset;)
1415
wdenkb79a11c2004-03-25 15:14:43 +00001416 - "videomode=bootargs" all the video parameters are parsed
Marcel Ziswiler7817cb22007-12-30 03:30:46 +01001417 from the bootargs. (See drivers/video/videomodes.c)
wdenkeeb1b772004-03-23 22:53:55 +00001418
1419
stroesec1551ea2003-04-04 15:53:41 +00001420 CONFIG_VIDEO_SED13806
wdenk43d96162003-03-06 00:02:04 +00001421 Enable Epson SED13806 driver. This driver supports 8bpp
wdenka6c7ad22002-12-03 21:28:10 +00001422 and 16bpp modes defined by CONFIG_VIDEO_SED13806_8BPP
1423 or CONFIG_VIDEO_SED13806_16BPP
1424
Timur Tabi7d3053f2011-02-15 17:09:19 -06001425 CONFIG_FSL_DIU_FB
Wolfgang Denk04e5ae72011-09-11 21:24:09 +02001426 Enable the Freescale DIU video driver. Reference boards for
Timur Tabi7d3053f2011-02-15 17:09:19 -06001427 SOCs that have a DIU should define this macro to enable DIU
1428 support, and should also define these other macros:
1429
1430 CONFIG_SYS_DIU_ADDR
1431 CONFIG_VIDEO
1432 CONFIG_CMD_BMP
1433 CONFIG_CFB_CONSOLE
1434 CONFIG_VIDEO_SW_CURSOR
1435 CONFIG_VGA_AS_SINGLE_DEVICE
1436 CONFIG_VIDEO_LOGO
1437 CONFIG_VIDEO_BMP_LOGO
1438
Timur Tabiba8e76b2011-04-11 14:18:22 -05001439 The DIU driver will look for the 'video-mode' environment
1440 variable, and if defined, enable the DIU as a console during
1441 boot. See the documentation file README.video for a
1442 description of this variable.
Timur Tabi7d3053f2011-02-15 17:09:19 -06001443
Simon Glass058d59b2012-12-03 13:59:47 +00001444 CONFIG_VIDEO_VGA
1445
1446 Enable the VGA video / BIOS for x86. The alternative if you
1447 are using coreboot is to use the coreboot frame buffer
1448 driver.
1449
1450
wdenk682011f2003-06-03 23:54:09 +00001451- Keyboard Support:
wdenk8bde7f72003-06-27 21:31:46 +00001452 CONFIG_KEYBOARD
wdenk682011f2003-06-03 23:54:09 +00001453
wdenk8bde7f72003-06-27 21:31:46 +00001454 Define this to enable a custom keyboard support.
1455 This simply calls drv_keyboard_init() which must be
1456 defined in your board-specific files.
1457 The only board using this so far is RBC823.
wdenka6c7ad22002-12-03 21:28:10 +00001458
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001459- LCD Support: CONFIG_LCD
1460
1461 Define this to enable LCD support (for output to LCD
1462 display); also select one of the supported displays
1463 by defining one of these:
1464
Stelian Pop39cf4802008-05-09 21:57:18 +02001465 CONFIG_ATMEL_LCD:
1466
1467 HITACHI TX09D70VM1CCA, 3.5", 240x320.
1468
wdenkfd3103b2003-11-25 16:55:19 +00001469 CONFIG_NEC_NL6448AC33:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001470
wdenkfd3103b2003-11-25 16:55:19 +00001471 NEC NL6448AC33-18. Active, color, single scan.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001472
wdenkfd3103b2003-11-25 16:55:19 +00001473 CONFIG_NEC_NL6448BC20
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001474
wdenkfd3103b2003-11-25 16:55:19 +00001475 NEC NL6448BC20-08. 6.5", 640x480.
1476 Active, color, single scan.
1477
1478 CONFIG_NEC_NL6448BC33_54
1479
1480 NEC NL6448BC33-54. 10.4", 640x480.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001481 Active, color, single scan.
1482
1483 CONFIG_SHARP_16x9
1484
1485 Sharp 320x240. Active, color, single scan.
1486 It isn't 16x9, and I am not sure what it is.
1487
1488 CONFIG_SHARP_LQ64D341
1489
1490 Sharp LQ64D341 display, 640x480.
1491 Active, color, single scan.
1492
1493 CONFIG_HLD1045
1494
1495 HLD1045 display, 640x480.
1496 Active, color, single scan.
1497
1498 CONFIG_OPTREX_BW
1499
1500 Optrex CBL50840-2 NF-FW 99 22 M5
1501 or
1502 Hitachi LMG6912RPFC-00T
1503 or
1504 Hitachi SP14Q002
1505
1506 320x240. Black & white.
1507
1508 Normally display is black on white background; define
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02001509 CONFIG_SYS_WHITE_ON_BLACK to get it inverted.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001510
Simon Glass676d3192012-10-17 13:24:54 +00001511 CONFIG_LCD_ALIGNMENT
1512
1513 Normally the LCD is page-aligned (tyically 4KB). If this is
1514 defined then the LCD will be aligned to this value instead.
1515 For ARM it is sometimes useful to use MMU_SECTION_SIZE
1516 here, since it is cheaper to change data cache settings on
1517 a per-section basis.
1518
Simon Glass0d89efe2012-10-17 13:24:59 +00001519 CONFIG_CONSOLE_SCROLL_LINES
1520
1521 When the console need to be scrolled, this is the number of
1522 lines to scroll by. It defaults to 1. Increasing this makes
1523 the console jump but can help speed up operation when scrolling
1524 is slow.
Simon Glass676d3192012-10-17 13:24:54 +00001525
Tom Wai-Hong Tam45d7f522012-09-28 15:11:16 +00001526 CONFIG_LCD_BMP_RLE8
1527
1528 Support drawing of RLE8-compressed bitmaps on the LCD.
1529
Tom Wai-Hong Tam735987c2012-12-05 14:46:40 +00001530 CONFIG_I2C_EDID
1531
1532 Enables an 'i2c edid' command which can read EDID
1533 information over I2C from an attached LCD display.
1534
wdenk7152b1d2003-09-05 23:19:14 +00001535- Splash Screen Support: CONFIG_SPLASH_SCREEN
wdenkd791b1d2003-04-20 14:04:18 +00001536
wdenk8bde7f72003-06-27 21:31:46 +00001537 If this option is set, the environment is checked for
1538 a variable "splashimage". If found, the usual display
1539 of logo, copyright and system information on the LCD
wdenke94d2cd2004-06-30 22:59:18 +00001540 is suppressed and the BMP image at the address
wdenk8bde7f72003-06-27 21:31:46 +00001541 specified in "splashimage" is loaded instead. The
1542 console is redirected to the "nulldev", too. This
1543 allows for a "silent" boot where a splash screen is
1544 loaded very quickly after power-on.
wdenkd791b1d2003-04-20 14:04:18 +00001545
Nikita Kiryanovc0880482013-02-24 21:28:43 +00001546 CONFIG_SPLASHIMAGE_GUARD
1547
1548 If this option is set, then U-Boot will prevent the environment
1549 variable "splashimage" from being set to a problematic address
1550 (see README.displaying-bmps and README.arm-unaligned-accesses).
1551 This option is useful for targets where, due to alignment
1552 restrictions, an improperly aligned BMP image will cause a data
1553 abort. If you think you will not have problems with unaligned
1554 accesses (for example because your toolchain prevents them)
1555 there is no need to set this option.
1556
Matthias Weisser1ca298c2009-07-09 16:07:30 +02001557 CONFIG_SPLASH_SCREEN_ALIGN
1558
1559 If this option is set the splash image can be freely positioned
1560 on the screen. Environment variable "splashpos" specifies the
1561 position as "x,y". If a positive number is given it is used as
1562 number of pixel from left/top. If a negative number is given it
1563 is used as number of pixel from right/bottom. You can also
1564 specify 'm' for centering the image.
1565
1566 Example:
1567 setenv splashpos m,m
1568 => image at center of screen
1569
1570 setenv splashpos 30,20
1571 => image at x = 30 and y = 20
1572
1573 setenv splashpos -10,m
1574 => vertically centered image
1575 at x = dspWidth - bmpWidth - 9
1576
Nikita Kiryanov581bb412013-01-30 21:39:57 +00001577 CONFIG_SPLASH_SCREEN_PREPARE
1578
1579 If this option is set then the board_splash_screen_prepare()
1580 function, which must be defined in your code, is called as part
1581 of the splash screen display sequence. It gives the board an
1582 opportunity to prepare the splash image data before it is
1583 processed and sent to the frame buffer by U-Boot.
1584
Stefan Roese98f4a3d2005-09-22 09:04:17 +02001585- Gzip compressed BMP image support: CONFIG_VIDEO_BMP_GZIP
1586
1587 If this option is set, additionally to standard BMP
1588 images, gzipped BMP images can be displayed via the
1589 splashscreen support or the bmp command.
1590
Anatolij Gustschind5011762010-03-15 14:50:25 +01001591- Run length encoded BMP image (RLE8) support: CONFIG_VIDEO_BMP_RLE8
1592
1593 If this option is set, 8-bit RLE compressed BMP images
1594 can be displayed via the splashscreen support or the
1595 bmp command.
1596
Lei Wenf2b96df2012-09-28 04:26:47 +00001597- Do compresssing for memory range:
1598 CONFIG_CMD_ZIP
1599
1600 If this option is set, it would use zlib deflate method
1601 to compress the specified memory at its best effort.
1602
wdenkc29fdfc2003-08-29 20:57:53 +00001603- Compression support:
1604 CONFIG_BZIP2
1605
1606 If this option is set, support for bzip2 compressed
1607 images is included. If not, only uncompressed and gzip
1608 compressed images are supported.
1609
wdenk42d1f032003-10-15 23:53:47 +00001610 NOTE: the bzip2 algorithm requires a lot of RAM, so
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02001611 the malloc area (as defined by CONFIG_SYS_MALLOC_LEN) should
wdenk42d1f032003-10-15 23:53:47 +00001612 be at least 4MB.
wdenkd791b1d2003-04-20 14:04:18 +00001613
Luigi 'Comio' Mantellinifc9c1722008-09-08 02:46:13 +02001614 CONFIG_LZMA
1615
1616 If this option is set, support for lzma compressed
1617 images is included.
1618
1619 Note: The LZMA algorithm adds between 2 and 4KB of code and it
1620 requires an amount of dynamic memory that is given by the
1621 formula:
1622
1623 (1846 + 768 << (lc + lp)) * sizeof(uint16)
1624
1625 Where lc and lp stand for, respectively, Literal context bits
1626 and Literal pos bits.
1627
1628 This value is upper-bounded by 14MB in the worst case. Anyway,
1629 for a ~4MB large kernel image, we have lc=3 and lp=0 for a
1630 total amount of (1846 + 768 << (3 + 0)) * 2 = ~41KB... that is
1631 a very small buffer.
1632
1633 Use the lzmainfo tool to determinate the lc and lp values and
1634 then calculate the amount of needed dynamic memory (ensuring
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02001635 the appropriate CONFIG_SYS_MALLOC_LEN value).
Luigi 'Comio' Mantellinifc9c1722008-09-08 02:46:13 +02001636
wdenk17ea1172004-06-06 21:51:03 +00001637- MII/PHY support:
1638 CONFIG_PHY_ADDR
1639
1640 The address of PHY on MII bus.
1641
1642 CONFIG_PHY_CLOCK_FREQ (ppc4xx)
1643
1644 The clock frequency of the MII bus
1645
1646 CONFIG_PHY_GIGE
1647
1648 If this option is set, support for speed/duplex
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02001649 detection of gigabit PHY is included.
wdenk17ea1172004-06-06 21:51:03 +00001650
1651 CONFIG_PHY_RESET_DELAY
1652
1653 Some PHY like Intel LXT971A need extra delay after
1654 reset before any MII register access is possible.
1655 For such PHY, set this option to the usec delay
1656 required. (minimum 300usec for LXT971A)
1657
1658 CONFIG_PHY_CMD_DELAY (ppc4xx)
1659
1660 Some PHY like Intel LXT971A need extra delay after
1661 command issued before MII status register can be read
1662
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001663- Ethernet address:
1664 CONFIG_ETHADDR
richardretanubunc68a05f2008-09-29 18:28:23 -04001665 CONFIG_ETH1ADDR
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001666 CONFIG_ETH2ADDR
1667 CONFIG_ETH3ADDR
richardretanubunc68a05f2008-09-29 18:28:23 -04001668 CONFIG_ETH4ADDR
1669 CONFIG_ETH5ADDR
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001670
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02001671 Define a default value for Ethernet address to use
1672 for the respective Ethernet interface, in case this
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001673 is not determined automatically.
1674
1675- IP address:
1676 CONFIG_IPADDR
1677
1678 Define a default value for the IP address to use for
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02001679 the default Ethernet interface, in case this is not
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001680 determined through e.g. bootp.
Wolfgang Denk1ebcd652011-10-26 10:21:22 +00001681 (Environment variable "ipaddr")
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001682
1683- Server IP address:
1684 CONFIG_SERVERIP
1685
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02001686 Defines a default value for the IP address of a TFTP
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001687 server to contact when using the "tftboot" command.
Wolfgang Denk1ebcd652011-10-26 10:21:22 +00001688 (Environment variable "serverip")
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001689
Robin Getz97cfe862009-07-21 12:15:28 -04001690 CONFIG_KEEP_SERVERADDR
1691
1692 Keeps the server's MAC address, in the env 'serveraddr'
1693 for passing to bootargs (like Linux's netconsole option)
1694
Wolfgang Denk1ebcd652011-10-26 10:21:22 +00001695- Gateway IP address:
1696 CONFIG_GATEWAYIP
1697
1698 Defines a default value for the IP address of the
1699 default router where packets to other networks are
1700 sent to.
1701 (Environment variable "gatewayip")
1702
1703- Subnet mask:
1704 CONFIG_NETMASK
1705
1706 Defines a default value for the subnet mask (or
1707 routing prefix) which is used to determine if an IP
1708 address belongs to the local subnet or needs to be
1709 forwarded through a router.
1710 (Environment variable "netmask")
1711
David Updegraff53a5c422007-06-11 10:41:07 -05001712- Multicast TFTP Mode:
1713 CONFIG_MCAST_TFTP
1714
1715 Defines whether you want to support multicast TFTP as per
1716 rfc-2090; for example to work with atftp. Lets lots of targets
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02001717 tftp down the same boot image concurrently. Note: the Ethernet
David Updegraff53a5c422007-06-11 10:41:07 -05001718 driver in use must provide a function: mcast() to join/leave a
1719 multicast group.
1720
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001721- BOOTP Recovery Mode:
1722 CONFIG_BOOTP_RANDOM_DELAY
1723
1724 If you have many targets in a network that try to
1725 boot using BOOTP, you may want to avoid that all
1726 systems send out BOOTP requests at precisely the same
1727 moment (which would happen for instance at recovery
1728 from a power failure, when all systems will try to
1729 boot, thus flooding the BOOTP server. Defining
1730 CONFIG_BOOTP_RANDOM_DELAY causes a random delay to be
1731 inserted before sending out BOOTP requests. The
Wolfgang Denk6c33c782007-08-06 23:21:05 +02001732 following delays are inserted then:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001733
1734 1st BOOTP request: delay 0 ... 1 sec
1735 2nd BOOTP request: delay 0 ... 2 sec
1736 3rd BOOTP request: delay 0 ... 4 sec
1737 4th and following
1738 BOOTP requests: delay 0 ... 8 sec
1739
stroesefe389a82003-08-28 14:17:32 +00001740- DHCP Advanced Options:
Jon Loeliger1fe80d72007-07-09 22:08:34 -05001741 You can fine tune the DHCP functionality by defining
1742 CONFIG_BOOTP_* symbols:
stroesefe389a82003-08-28 14:17:32 +00001743
Jon Loeliger1fe80d72007-07-09 22:08:34 -05001744 CONFIG_BOOTP_SUBNETMASK
1745 CONFIG_BOOTP_GATEWAY
1746 CONFIG_BOOTP_HOSTNAME
1747 CONFIG_BOOTP_NISDOMAIN
1748 CONFIG_BOOTP_BOOTPATH
1749 CONFIG_BOOTP_BOOTFILESIZE
1750 CONFIG_BOOTP_DNS
1751 CONFIG_BOOTP_DNS2
1752 CONFIG_BOOTP_SEND_HOSTNAME
1753 CONFIG_BOOTP_NTPSERVER
1754 CONFIG_BOOTP_TIMEOFFSET
1755 CONFIG_BOOTP_VENDOREX
Joe Hershberger2c00e092012-05-23 07:59:19 +00001756 CONFIG_BOOTP_MAY_FAIL
stroesefe389a82003-08-28 14:17:32 +00001757
Wilson Callan5d110f02007-07-28 10:56:13 -04001758 CONFIG_BOOTP_SERVERIP - TFTP server will be the serverip
1759 environment variable, not the BOOTP server.
stroesefe389a82003-08-28 14:17:32 +00001760
Joe Hershberger2c00e092012-05-23 07:59:19 +00001761 CONFIG_BOOTP_MAY_FAIL - If the DHCP server is not found
1762 after the configured retry count, the call will fail
1763 instead of starting over. This can be used to fail over
1764 to Link-local IP address configuration if the DHCP server
1765 is not available.
1766
stroesefe389a82003-08-28 14:17:32 +00001767 CONFIG_BOOTP_DNS2 - If a DHCP client requests the DNS
1768 serverip from a DHCP server, it is possible that more
1769 than one DNS serverip is offered to the client.
1770 If CONFIG_BOOTP_DNS2 is enabled, the secondary DNS
1771 serverip will be stored in the additional environment
1772 variable "dnsip2". The first DNS serverip is always
1773 stored in the variable "dnsip", when CONFIG_BOOTP_DNS
Jon Loeliger1fe80d72007-07-09 22:08:34 -05001774 is defined.
stroesefe389a82003-08-28 14:17:32 +00001775
1776 CONFIG_BOOTP_SEND_HOSTNAME - Some DHCP servers are capable
1777 to do a dynamic update of a DNS server. To do this, they
1778 need the hostname of the DHCP requester.
Wilson Callan5d110f02007-07-28 10:56:13 -04001779 If CONFIG_BOOTP_SEND_HOSTNAME is defined, the content
Jon Loeliger1fe80d72007-07-09 22:08:34 -05001780 of the "hostname" environment variable is passed as
1781 option 12 to the DHCP server.
stroesefe389a82003-08-28 14:17:32 +00001782
Aras Vaichasd9a2f412008-03-26 09:43:57 +11001783 CONFIG_BOOTP_DHCP_REQUEST_DELAY
1784
1785 A 32bit value in microseconds for a delay between
1786 receiving a "DHCP Offer" and sending the "DHCP Request".
1787 This fixes a problem with certain DHCP servers that don't
1788 respond 100% of the time to a "DHCP request". E.g. On an
1789 AT91RM9200 processor running at 180MHz, this delay needed
1790 to be *at least* 15,000 usec before a Windows Server 2003
1791 DHCP server would reply 100% of the time. I recommend at
1792 least 50,000 usec to be safe. The alternative is to hope
1793 that one of the retries will be successful but note that
1794 the DHCP timeout and retry process takes a longer than
1795 this delay.
1796
Joe Hershbergerd22c3382012-05-23 08:00:12 +00001797 - Link-local IP address negotiation:
1798 Negotiate with other link-local clients on the local network
1799 for an address that doesn't require explicit configuration.
1800 This is especially useful if a DHCP server cannot be guaranteed
1801 to exist in all environments that the device must operate.
1802
1803 See doc/README.link-local for more information.
1804
wdenka3d991b2004-04-15 21:48:45 +00001805 - CDP Options:
wdenk6e592382004-04-18 17:39:38 +00001806 CONFIG_CDP_DEVICE_ID
wdenka3d991b2004-04-15 21:48:45 +00001807
1808 The device id used in CDP trigger frames.
1809
1810 CONFIG_CDP_DEVICE_ID_PREFIX
1811
1812 A two character string which is prefixed to the MAC address
1813 of the device.
1814
1815 CONFIG_CDP_PORT_ID
1816
1817 A printf format string which contains the ascii name of
1818 the port. Normally is set to "eth%d" which sets
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02001819 eth0 for the first Ethernet, eth1 for the second etc.
wdenka3d991b2004-04-15 21:48:45 +00001820
1821 CONFIG_CDP_CAPABILITIES
1822
1823 A 32bit integer which indicates the device capabilities;
1824 0x00000010 for a normal host which does not forwards.
1825
1826 CONFIG_CDP_VERSION
1827
1828 An ascii string containing the version of the software.
1829
1830 CONFIG_CDP_PLATFORM
1831
1832 An ascii string containing the name of the platform.
1833
1834 CONFIG_CDP_TRIGGER
1835
1836 A 32bit integer sent on the trigger.
1837
1838 CONFIG_CDP_POWER_CONSUMPTION
1839
1840 A 16bit integer containing the power consumption of the
1841 device in .1 of milliwatts.
1842
1843 CONFIG_CDP_APPLIANCE_VLAN_TYPE
1844
1845 A byte containing the id of the VLAN.
1846
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001847- Status LED: CONFIG_STATUS_LED
1848
1849 Several configurations allow to display the current
1850 status using a LED. For instance, the LED will blink
1851 fast while running U-Boot code, stop blinking as
1852 soon as a reply to a BOOTP request was received, and
1853 start blinking slow once the Linux kernel is running
1854 (supported by a status LED driver in the Linux
1855 kernel). Defining CONFIG_STATUS_LED enables this
1856 feature in U-Boot.
1857
1858- CAN Support: CONFIG_CAN_DRIVER
1859
1860 Defining CONFIG_CAN_DRIVER enables CAN driver support
1861 on those systems that support this (optional)
1862 feature, like the TQM8xxL modules.
1863
1864- I2C Support: CONFIG_HARD_I2C | CONFIG_SOFT_I2C
1865
wdenkb37c7e52003-06-30 16:24:52 +00001866 These enable I2C serial bus commands. Defining either of
wdenk945af8d2003-07-16 21:53:01 +00001867 (but not both of) CONFIG_HARD_I2C or CONFIG_SOFT_I2C will
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02001868 include the appropriate I2C driver for the selected CPU.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001869
wdenk945af8d2003-07-16 21:53:01 +00001870 This will allow you to use i2c commands at the u-boot
Jon Loeliger602ad3b2007-06-11 19:03:39 -05001871 command line (as long as you set CONFIG_CMD_I2C in
wdenkb37c7e52003-06-30 16:24:52 +00001872 CONFIG_COMMANDS) and communicate with i2c based realtime
1873 clock chips. See common/cmd_i2c.c for a description of the
wdenk43d96162003-03-06 00:02:04 +00001874 command line interface.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001875
Ben Warrenbb99ad62006-09-07 16:50:54 -04001876 CONFIG_HARD_I2C selects a hardware I2C controller.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001877
wdenk945af8d2003-07-16 21:53:01 +00001878 CONFIG_SOFT_I2C configures u-boot to use a software (aka
wdenkb37c7e52003-06-30 16:24:52 +00001879 bit-banging) driver instead of CPM or similar hardware
1880 support for I2C.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001881
wdenk945af8d2003-07-16 21:53:01 +00001882 There are several other quantities that must also be
wdenkb37c7e52003-06-30 16:24:52 +00001883 defined when you define CONFIG_HARD_I2C or CONFIG_SOFT_I2C.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001884
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02001885 In both cases you will need to define CONFIG_SYS_I2C_SPEED
wdenk945af8d2003-07-16 21:53:01 +00001886 to be the frequency (in Hz) at which you wish your i2c bus
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02001887 to run and CONFIG_SYS_I2C_SLAVE to be the address of this node (ie
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02001888 the CPU's i2c node address).
wdenk945af8d2003-07-16 21:53:01 +00001889
Peter Tyser8d321b82010-04-12 22:28:21 -05001890 Now, the u-boot i2c code for the mpc8xx
Stefan Roesea47a12b2010-04-15 16:07:28 +02001891 (arch/powerpc/cpu/mpc8xx/i2c.c) sets the CPU up as a master node
Peter Tyser8d321b82010-04-12 22:28:21 -05001892 and so its address should therefore be cleared to 0 (See,
1893 eg, MPC823e User's Manual p.16-473). So, set
1894 CONFIG_SYS_I2C_SLAVE to 0.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001895
Eric Millbrandt5da71ef2009-09-03 08:09:44 -05001896 CONFIG_SYS_I2C_INIT_MPC5XXX
1897
1898 When a board is reset during an i2c bus transfer
1899 chips might think that the current transfer is still
1900 in progress. Reset the slave devices by sending start
1901 commands until the slave device responds.
1902
wdenk945af8d2003-07-16 21:53:01 +00001903 That's all that's required for CONFIG_HARD_I2C.
wdenkb37c7e52003-06-30 16:24:52 +00001904
1905 If you use the software i2c interface (CONFIG_SOFT_I2C)
1906 then the following macros need to be defined (examples are
1907 from include/configs/lwmon.h):
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001908
1909 I2C_INIT
1910
wdenkb37c7e52003-06-30 16:24:52 +00001911 (Optional). Any commands necessary to enable the I2C
wdenk43d96162003-03-06 00:02:04 +00001912 controller or configure ports.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001913
wdenkba56f622004-02-06 23:19:44 +00001914 eg: #define I2C_INIT (immr->im_cpm.cp_pbdir |= PB_SCL)
wdenkb37c7e52003-06-30 16:24:52 +00001915
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001916 I2C_PORT
1917
wdenk43d96162003-03-06 00:02:04 +00001918 (Only for MPC8260 CPU). The I/O port to use (the code
1919 assumes both bits are on the same port). Valid values
1920 are 0..3 for ports A..D.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001921
1922 I2C_ACTIVE
1923
1924 The code necessary to make the I2C data line active
1925 (driven). If the data line is open collector, this
1926 define can be null.
1927
wdenkb37c7e52003-06-30 16:24:52 +00001928 eg: #define I2C_ACTIVE (immr->im_cpm.cp_pbdir |= PB_SDA)
1929
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001930 I2C_TRISTATE
1931
1932 The code necessary to make the I2C data line tri-stated
1933 (inactive). If the data line is open collector, this
1934 define can be null.
1935
wdenkb37c7e52003-06-30 16:24:52 +00001936 eg: #define I2C_TRISTATE (immr->im_cpm.cp_pbdir &= ~PB_SDA)
1937
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001938 I2C_READ
1939
1940 Code that returns TRUE if the I2C data line is high,
1941 FALSE if it is low.
1942
wdenkb37c7e52003-06-30 16:24:52 +00001943 eg: #define I2C_READ ((immr->im_cpm.cp_pbdat & PB_SDA) != 0)
1944
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001945 I2C_SDA(bit)
1946
1947 If <bit> is TRUE, sets the I2C data line high. If it
1948 is FALSE, it clears it (low).
1949
wdenkb37c7e52003-06-30 16:24:52 +00001950 eg: #define I2C_SDA(bit) \
wdenk2535d602003-07-17 23:16:40 +00001951 if(bit) immr->im_cpm.cp_pbdat |= PB_SDA; \
wdenkba56f622004-02-06 23:19:44 +00001952 else immr->im_cpm.cp_pbdat &= ~PB_SDA
wdenkb37c7e52003-06-30 16:24:52 +00001953
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001954 I2C_SCL(bit)
1955
1956 If <bit> is TRUE, sets the I2C clock line high. If it
1957 is FALSE, it clears it (low).
1958
wdenkb37c7e52003-06-30 16:24:52 +00001959 eg: #define I2C_SCL(bit) \
wdenk2535d602003-07-17 23:16:40 +00001960 if(bit) immr->im_cpm.cp_pbdat |= PB_SCL; \
wdenkba56f622004-02-06 23:19:44 +00001961 else immr->im_cpm.cp_pbdat &= ~PB_SCL
wdenkb37c7e52003-06-30 16:24:52 +00001962
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001963 I2C_DELAY
1964
1965 This delay is invoked four times per clock cycle so this
1966 controls the rate of data transfer. The data rate thus
wdenkb37c7e52003-06-30 16:24:52 +00001967 is 1 / (I2C_DELAY * 4). Often defined to be something
wdenk945af8d2003-07-16 21:53:01 +00001968 like:
1969
wdenkb37c7e52003-06-30 16:24:52 +00001970 #define I2C_DELAY udelay(2)
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00001971
Mike Frysinger793b5722010-07-21 13:38:02 -04001972 CONFIG_SOFT_I2C_GPIO_SCL / CONFIG_SOFT_I2C_GPIO_SDA
1973
1974 If your arch supports the generic GPIO framework (asm/gpio.h),
1975 then you may alternatively define the two GPIOs that are to be
1976 used as SCL / SDA. Any of the previous I2C_xxx macros will
1977 have GPIO-based defaults assigned to them as appropriate.
1978
1979 You should define these to the GPIO value as given directly to
1980 the generic GPIO functions.
1981
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02001982 CONFIG_SYS_I2C_INIT_BOARD
wdenk47cd00f2003-03-06 13:39:27 +00001983
wdenk8bde7f72003-06-27 21:31:46 +00001984 When a board is reset during an i2c bus transfer
1985 chips might think that the current transfer is still
1986 in progress. On some boards it is possible to access
1987 the i2c SCLK line directly, either by using the
1988 processor pin as a GPIO or by having a second pin
1989 connected to the bus. If this option is defined a
1990 custom i2c_init_board() routine in boards/xxx/board.c
1991 is run early in the boot sequence.
wdenk47cd00f2003-03-06 13:39:27 +00001992
Richard Retanubun26a33502010-04-12 15:08:17 -04001993 CONFIG_SYS_I2C_BOARD_LATE_INIT
1994
1995 An alternative to CONFIG_SYS_I2C_INIT_BOARD. If this option is
1996 defined a custom i2c_board_late_init() routine in
1997 boards/xxx/board.c is run AFTER the operations in i2c_init()
1998 is completed. This callpoint can be used to unreset i2c bus
1999 using CPU i2c controller register accesses for CPUs whose i2c
2000 controller provide such a method. It is called at the end of
2001 i2c_init() to allow i2c_init operations to setup the i2c bus
2002 controller on the CPU (e.g. setting bus speed & slave address).
2003
wdenk17ea1172004-06-06 21:51:03 +00002004 CONFIG_I2CFAST (PPC405GP|PPC405EP only)
2005
2006 This option enables configuration of bi_iic_fast[] flags
2007 in u-boot bd_info structure based on u-boot environment
2008 variable "i2cfast". (see also i2cfast)
2009
Ben Warrenbb99ad62006-09-07 16:50:54 -04002010 CONFIG_I2C_MULTI_BUS
2011
2012 This option allows the use of multiple I2C buses, each of which
Wolfgang Denkc0f40852011-10-26 10:21:21 +00002013 must have a controller. At any point in time, only one bus is
2014 active. To switch to a different bus, use the 'i2c dev' command.
Ben Warrenbb99ad62006-09-07 16:50:54 -04002015 Note that bus numbering is zero-based.
2016
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02002017 CONFIG_SYS_I2C_NOPROBES
Ben Warrenbb99ad62006-09-07 16:50:54 -04002018
2019 This option specifies a list of I2C devices that will be skipped
Wolfgang Denkc0f40852011-10-26 10:21:21 +00002020 when the 'i2c probe' command is issued. If CONFIG_I2C_MULTI_BUS
Peter Tyser0f89c542009-04-18 22:34:03 -05002021 is set, specify a list of bus-device pairs. Otherwise, specify
2022 a 1D array of device addresses
Ben Warrenbb99ad62006-09-07 16:50:54 -04002023
2024 e.g.
2025 #undef CONFIG_I2C_MULTI_BUS
Wolfgang Denkc0f40852011-10-26 10:21:21 +00002026 #define CONFIG_SYS_I2C_NOPROBES {0x50,0x68}
Ben Warrenbb99ad62006-09-07 16:50:54 -04002027
2028 will skip addresses 0x50 and 0x68 on a board with one I2C bus
2029
Wolfgang Denkc0f40852011-10-26 10:21:21 +00002030 #define CONFIG_I2C_MULTI_BUS
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02002031 #define CONFIG_SYS_I2C_MULTI_NOPROBES {{0,0x50},{0,0x68},{1,0x54}}
Ben Warrenbb99ad62006-09-07 16:50:54 -04002032
2033 will skip addresses 0x50 and 0x68 on bus 0 and address 0x54 on bus 1
2034
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02002035 CONFIG_SYS_SPD_BUS_NUM
Timur Tabibe5e6182006-11-03 19:15:00 -06002036
2037 If defined, then this indicates the I2C bus number for DDR SPD.
2038 If not defined, then U-Boot assumes that SPD is on I2C bus 0.
2039
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02002040 CONFIG_SYS_RTC_BUS_NUM
Stefan Roese0dc018e2007-02-20 10:51:26 +01002041
2042 If defined, then this indicates the I2C bus number for the RTC.
2043 If not defined, then U-Boot assumes that RTC is on I2C bus 0.
2044
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02002045 CONFIG_SYS_DTT_BUS_NUM
Stefan Roese0dc018e2007-02-20 10:51:26 +01002046
2047 If defined, then this indicates the I2C bus number for the DTT.
2048 If not defined, then U-Boot assumes that DTT is on I2C bus 0.
2049
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02002050 CONFIG_SYS_I2C_DTT_ADDR:
Victor Gallardo9ebbb542008-09-09 15:13:29 -07002051
2052 If defined, specifies the I2C address of the DTT device.
2053 If not defined, then U-Boot uses predefined value for
2054 specified DTT device.
2055
Timur Tabibe5e6182006-11-03 19:15:00 -06002056 CONFIG_FSL_I2C
2057
2058 Define this option if you want to use Freescale's I2C driver in
Marcel Ziswiler7817cb22007-12-30 03:30:46 +01002059 drivers/i2c/fsl_i2c.c.
Timur Tabibe5e6182006-11-03 19:15:00 -06002060
Heiko Schocher67b23a32008-10-15 09:39:47 +02002061 CONFIG_I2C_MUX
2062
2063 Define this option if you have I2C devices reached over 1 .. n
2064 I2C Muxes like the pca9544a. This option addes a new I2C
2065 Command "i2c bus [muxtype:muxaddr:muxchannel]" which adds a
2066 new I2C Bus to the existing I2C Busses. If you select the
2067 new Bus with "i2c dev", u-bbot sends first the commandos for
2068 the muxes to activate this new "bus".
2069
2070 CONFIG_I2C_MULTI_BUS must be also defined, to use this
2071 feature!
2072
2073 Example:
2074 Adding a new I2C Bus reached over 2 pca9544a muxes
2075 The First mux with address 70 and channel 6
2076 The Second mux with address 71 and channel 4
2077
2078 => i2c bus pca9544a:70:6:pca9544a:71:4
2079
2080 Use the "i2c bus" command without parameter, to get a list
2081 of I2C Busses with muxes:
2082
2083 => i2c bus
2084 Busses reached over muxes:
2085 Bus ID: 2
2086 reached over Mux(es):
2087 pca9544a@70 ch: 4
2088 Bus ID: 3
2089 reached over Mux(es):
2090 pca9544a@70 ch: 6
2091 pca9544a@71 ch: 4
2092 =>
2093
2094 If you now switch to the new I2C Bus 3 with "i2c dev 3"
Michael Jonesf9a78b82011-07-14 22:09:28 +00002095 u-boot first sends the command to the mux@70 to enable
2096 channel 6, and then the command to the mux@71 to enable
Heiko Schocher67b23a32008-10-15 09:39:47 +02002097 the channel 4.
2098
2099 After that, you can use the "normal" i2c commands as
Michael Jonesf9a78b82011-07-14 22:09:28 +00002100 usual to communicate with your I2C devices behind
Heiko Schocher67b23a32008-10-15 09:39:47 +02002101 the 2 muxes.
2102
2103 This option is actually implemented for the bitbanging
2104 algorithm in common/soft_i2c.c and for the Hardware I2C
2105 Bus on the MPC8260. But it should be not so difficult
2106 to add this option to other architectures.
2107
Andrew Dyer2ac69852008-12-29 17:36:01 -06002108 CONFIG_SOFT_I2C_READ_REPEATED_START
2109
2110 defining this will force the i2c_read() function in
2111 the soft_i2c driver to perform an I2C repeated start
2112 between writing the address pointer and reading the
2113 data. If this define is omitted the default behaviour
2114 of doing a stop-start sequence will be used. Most I2C
2115 devices can use either method, but some require one or
2116 the other.
Timur Tabibe5e6182006-11-03 19:15:00 -06002117
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002118- SPI Support: CONFIG_SPI
2119
2120 Enables SPI driver (so far only tested with
2121 SPI EEPROM, also an instance works with Crystal A/D and
2122 D/As on the SACSng board)
2123
Yoshihiro Shimoda66395622011-01-31 16:50:43 +09002124 CONFIG_SH_SPI
2125
2126 Enables the driver for SPI controller on SuperH. Currently
2127 only SH7757 is supported.
2128
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002129 CONFIG_SPI_X
2130
2131 Enables extended (16-bit) SPI EEPROM addressing.
2132 (symmetrical to CONFIG_I2C_X)
2133
2134 CONFIG_SOFT_SPI
2135
wdenk43d96162003-03-06 00:02:04 +00002136 Enables a software (bit-bang) SPI driver rather than
2137 using hardware support. This is a general purpose
2138 driver that only requires three general I/O port pins
2139 (two outputs, one input) to function. If this is
2140 defined, the board configuration must define several
2141 SPI configuration items (port pins to use, etc). For
2142 an example, see include/configs/sacsng.h.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002143
Ben Warren04a9e112008-01-16 22:37:35 -05002144 CONFIG_HARD_SPI
2145
2146 Enables a hardware SPI driver for general-purpose reads
2147 and writes. As with CONFIG_SOFT_SPI, the board configuration
2148 must define a list of chip-select function pointers.
Wolfgang Denkc0f40852011-10-26 10:21:21 +00002149 Currently supported on some MPC8xxx processors. For an
Ben Warren04a9e112008-01-16 22:37:35 -05002150 example, see include/configs/mpc8349emds.h.
2151
Guennadi Liakhovetski38254f42008-04-15 14:14:25 +02002152 CONFIG_MXC_SPI
2153
2154 Enables the driver for the SPI controllers on i.MX and MXC
Fabio Estevam2e3cd1c2011-10-28 08:57:46 +00002155 SoCs. Currently i.MX31/35/51 are supported.
Guennadi Liakhovetski38254f42008-04-15 14:14:25 +02002156
Matthias Fuchs01335022007-12-27 17:12:34 +01002157- FPGA Support: CONFIG_FPGA
2158
2159 Enables FPGA subsystem.
2160
2161 CONFIG_FPGA_<vendor>
2162
2163 Enables support for specific chip vendors.
2164 (ALTERA, XILINX)
2165
2166 CONFIG_FPGA_<family>
2167
2168 Enables support for FPGA family.
2169 (SPARTAN2, SPARTAN3, VIRTEX2, CYCLONE2, ACEX1K, ACEX)
2170
2171 CONFIG_FPGA_COUNT
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002172
wdenk43d96162003-03-06 00:02:04 +00002173 Specify the number of FPGA devices to support.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002174
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02002175 CONFIG_SYS_FPGA_PROG_FEEDBACK
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002176
wdenk8bde7f72003-06-27 21:31:46 +00002177 Enable printing of hash marks during FPGA configuration.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002178
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02002179 CONFIG_SYS_FPGA_CHECK_BUSY
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002180
wdenk43d96162003-03-06 00:02:04 +00002181 Enable checks on FPGA configuration interface busy
2182 status by the configuration function. This option
2183 will require a board or device specific function to
2184 be written.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002185
2186 CONFIG_FPGA_DELAY
2187
2188 If defined, a function that provides delays in the FPGA
2189 configuration driver.
2190
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02002191 CONFIG_SYS_FPGA_CHECK_CTRLC
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002192 Allow Control-C to interrupt FPGA configuration
2193
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02002194 CONFIG_SYS_FPGA_CHECK_ERROR
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002195
wdenk43d96162003-03-06 00:02:04 +00002196 Check for configuration errors during FPGA bitfile
2197 loading. For example, abort during Virtex II
2198 configuration if the INIT_B line goes low (which
2199 indicated a CRC error).
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002200
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02002201 CONFIG_SYS_FPGA_WAIT_INIT
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002202
wdenk43d96162003-03-06 00:02:04 +00002203 Maximum time to wait for the INIT_B line to deassert
2204 after PROB_B has been deasserted during a Virtex II
2205 FPGA configuration sequence. The default time is 500
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02002206 ms.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002207
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02002208 CONFIG_SYS_FPGA_WAIT_BUSY
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002209
wdenk43d96162003-03-06 00:02:04 +00002210 Maximum time to wait for BUSY to deassert during
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02002211 Virtex II FPGA configuration. The default is 5 ms.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002212
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02002213 CONFIG_SYS_FPGA_WAIT_CONFIG
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002214
wdenk43d96162003-03-06 00:02:04 +00002215 Time to wait after FPGA configuration. The default is
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02002216 200 ms.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002217
2218- Configuration Management:
2219 CONFIG_IDENT_STRING
2220
wdenk43d96162003-03-06 00:02:04 +00002221 If defined, this string will be added to the U-Boot
2222 version information (U_BOOT_VERSION)
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002223
2224- Vendor Parameter Protection:
2225
wdenk43d96162003-03-06 00:02:04 +00002226 U-Boot considers the values of the environment
2227 variables "serial#" (Board Serial Number) and
wdenk7152b1d2003-09-05 23:19:14 +00002228 "ethaddr" (Ethernet Address) to be parameters that
wdenk43d96162003-03-06 00:02:04 +00002229 are set once by the board vendor / manufacturer, and
2230 protects these variables from casual modification by
2231 the user. Once set, these variables are read-only,
2232 and write or delete attempts are rejected. You can
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02002233 change this behaviour:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002234
2235 If CONFIG_ENV_OVERWRITE is #defined in your config
2236 file, the write protection for vendor parameters is
wdenk47cd00f2003-03-06 13:39:27 +00002237 completely disabled. Anybody can change or delete
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002238 these parameters.
2239
2240 Alternatively, if you #define _both_ CONFIG_ETHADDR
2241 _and_ CONFIG_OVERWRITE_ETHADDR_ONCE, a default
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02002242 Ethernet address is installed in the environment,
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002243 which can be changed exactly ONCE by the user. [The
2244 serial# is unaffected by this, i. e. it remains
2245 read-only.]
2246
Joe Hershberger25980902012-12-11 22:16:31 -06002247 The same can be accomplished in a more flexible way
2248 for any variable by configuring the type of access
2249 to allow for those variables in the ".flags" variable
2250 or define CONFIG_ENV_FLAGS_LIST_STATIC.
2251
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002252- Protected RAM:
2253 CONFIG_PRAM
2254
2255 Define this variable to enable the reservation of
2256 "protected RAM", i. e. RAM which is not overwritten
2257 by U-Boot. Define CONFIG_PRAM to hold the number of
2258 kB you want to reserve for pRAM. You can overwrite
2259 this default value by defining an environment
2260 variable "pram" to the number of kB you want to
2261 reserve. Note that the board info structure will
2262 still show the full amount of RAM. If pRAM is
2263 reserved, a new environment variable "mem" will
2264 automatically be defined to hold the amount of
2265 remaining RAM in a form that can be passed as boot
2266 argument to Linux, for instance like that:
2267
Wolfgang Denkfe126d82005-11-20 21:40:11 +01002268 setenv bootargs ... mem=\${mem}
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002269 saveenv
2270
2271 This way you can tell Linux not to use this memory,
2272 either, which results in a memory region that will
2273 not be affected by reboots.
2274
2275 *WARNING* If your board configuration uses automatic
2276 detection of the RAM size, you must make sure that
2277 this memory test is non-destructive. So far, the
2278 following board configurations are known to be
2279 "pRAM-clean":
2280
Wolfgang Denk1b0757e2012-10-24 02:36:15 +00002281 IVMS8, IVML24, SPD8xx, TQM8xxL,
2282 HERMES, IP860, RPXlite, LWMON,
Wolfgang Denk544d97e2010-10-05 22:54:53 +02002283 FLAGADM, TQM8260
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002284
Gabe Black40fef042012-12-02 04:55:18 +00002285- Access to physical memory region (> 4GB)
2286 Some basic support is provided for operations on memory not
2287 normally accessible to U-Boot - e.g. some architectures
2288 support access to more than 4GB of memory on 32-bit
2289 machines using physical address extension or similar.
2290 Define CONFIG_PHYSMEM to access this basic support, which
2291 currently only supports clearing the memory.
2292
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002293- Error Recovery:
2294 CONFIG_PANIC_HANG
2295
2296 Define this variable to stop the system in case of a
2297 fatal error, so that you have to reset it manually.
2298 This is probably NOT a good idea for an embedded
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02002299 system where you want the system to reboot
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002300 automatically as fast as possible, but it may be
2301 useful during development since you can try to debug
2302 the conditions that lead to the situation.
2303
2304 CONFIG_NET_RETRY_COUNT
2305
wdenk43d96162003-03-06 00:02:04 +00002306 This variable defines the number of retries for
2307 network operations like ARP, RARP, TFTP, or BOOTP
2308 before giving up the operation. If not defined, a
2309 default value of 5 is used.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002310
Guennadi Liakhovetski40cb90e2008-04-03 17:04:19 +02002311 CONFIG_ARP_TIMEOUT
2312
2313 Timeout waiting for an ARP reply in milliseconds.
2314
Tetsuyuki Kobayashi48a3e992012-07-03 22:25:21 +00002315 CONFIG_NFS_TIMEOUT
2316
2317 Timeout in milliseconds used in NFS protocol.
2318 If you encounter "ERROR: Cannot umount" in nfs command,
2319 try longer timeout such as
2320 #define CONFIG_NFS_TIMEOUT 10000UL
2321
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002322- Command Interpreter:
Wolfgang Denk8078f1a2006-10-28 02:28:02 +02002323 CONFIG_AUTO_COMPLETE
wdenk04a85b32004-04-15 18:22:41 +00002324
2325 Enable auto completion of commands using TAB.
2326
Wolfgang Denka9398e02006-11-27 15:32:42 +01002327 Note that this feature has NOT been implemented yet
2328 for the "hush" shell.
Wolfgang Denk8078f1a2006-10-28 02:28:02 +02002329
2330
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02002331 CONFIG_SYS_HUSH_PARSER
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002332
2333 Define this variable to enable the "hush" shell (from
2334 Busybox) as command line interpreter, thus enabling
2335 powerful command line syntax like
2336 if...then...else...fi conditionals or `&&' and '||'
2337 constructs ("shell scripts").
2338
2339 If undefined, you get the old, much simpler behaviour
2340 with a somewhat smaller memory footprint.
2341
2342
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02002343 CONFIG_SYS_PROMPT_HUSH_PS2
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002344
2345 This defines the secondary prompt string, which is
2346 printed when the command interpreter needs more input
2347 to complete a command. Usually "> ".
2348
2349 Note:
2350
wdenk8bde7f72003-06-27 21:31:46 +00002351 In the current implementation, the local variables
2352 space and global environment variables space are
2353 separated. Local variables are those you define by
2354 simply typing `name=value'. To access a local
2355 variable later on, you have write `$name' or
2356 `${name}'; to execute the contents of a variable
2357 directly type `$name' at the command prompt.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002358
wdenk43d96162003-03-06 00:02:04 +00002359 Global environment variables are those you use
2360 setenv/printenv to work with. To run a command stored
2361 in such a variable, you need to use the run command,
2362 and you must not use the '$' sign to access them.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002363
2364 To store commands and special characters in a
2365 variable, please use double quotation marks
2366 surrounding the whole text of the variable, instead
2367 of the backslashes before semicolons and special
2368 symbols.
2369
Wolfgang Denkaa0c71a2006-07-21 11:35:21 +02002370- Commandline Editing and History:
2371 CONFIG_CMDLINE_EDITING
2372
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02002373 Enable editing and History functions for interactive
Wolfgang Denkb9365a22006-07-21 11:56:05 +02002374 commandline input operations
Wolfgang Denkaa0c71a2006-07-21 11:35:21 +02002375
wdenka8c7c702003-12-06 19:49:23 +00002376- Default Environment:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002377 CONFIG_EXTRA_ENV_SETTINGS
2378
wdenk43d96162003-03-06 00:02:04 +00002379 Define this to contain any number of null terminated
2380 strings (variable = value pairs) that will be part of
wdenk7152b1d2003-09-05 23:19:14 +00002381 the default environment compiled into the boot image.
wdenk2262cfe2002-11-18 00:14:45 +00002382
wdenk43d96162003-03-06 00:02:04 +00002383 For example, place something like this in your
2384 board's config file:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002385
2386 #define CONFIG_EXTRA_ENV_SETTINGS \
2387 "myvar1=value1\0" \
2388 "myvar2=value2\0"
2389
wdenk43d96162003-03-06 00:02:04 +00002390 Warning: This method is based on knowledge about the
2391 internal format how the environment is stored by the
2392 U-Boot code. This is NOT an official, exported
2393 interface! Although it is unlikely that this format
wdenk7152b1d2003-09-05 23:19:14 +00002394 will change soon, there is no guarantee either.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002395 You better know what you are doing here.
2396
wdenk43d96162003-03-06 00:02:04 +00002397 Note: overly (ab)use of the default environment is
2398 discouraged. Make sure to check other ways to preset
Wolfgang Denk74de7ae2009-04-01 23:34:12 +02002399 the environment like the "source" command or the
wdenk43d96162003-03-06 00:02:04 +00002400 boot command first.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002401
Stephen Warren5e724ca2012-05-22 09:21:54 +00002402 CONFIG_ENV_VARS_UBOOT_CONFIG
2403
2404 Define this in order to add variables describing the
2405 U-Boot build configuration to the default environment.
2406 These will be named arch, cpu, board, vendor, and soc.
2407
2408 Enabling this option will cause the following to be defined:
2409
2410 - CONFIG_SYS_ARCH
2411 - CONFIG_SYS_CPU
2412 - CONFIG_SYS_BOARD
2413 - CONFIG_SYS_VENDOR
2414 - CONFIG_SYS_SOC
2415
Tom Rini7e27f892012-10-24 07:28:16 +00002416 CONFIG_ENV_VARS_UBOOT_RUNTIME_CONFIG
2417
2418 Define this in order to add variables describing certain
2419 run-time determined information about the hardware to the
2420 environment. These will be named board_name, board_rev.
2421
Simon Glass06fd8532012-11-30 13:01:17 +00002422 CONFIG_DELAY_ENVIRONMENT
2423
2424 Normally the environment is loaded when the board is
2425 intialised so that it is available to U-Boot. This inhibits
2426 that so that the environment is not available until
2427 explicitly loaded later by U-Boot code. With CONFIG_OF_CONTROL
2428 this is instead controlled by the value of
2429 /config/load-environment.
2430
wdenka8c7c702003-12-06 19:49:23 +00002431- DataFlash Support:
wdenk2abbe072003-06-16 23:50:08 +00002432 CONFIG_HAS_DATAFLASH
2433
wdenk8bde7f72003-06-27 21:31:46 +00002434 Defining this option enables DataFlash features and
2435 allows to read/write in Dataflash via the standard
2436 commands cp, md...
wdenk2abbe072003-06-16 23:50:08 +00002437
Eric Nelsonf61ec452012-01-31 10:52:08 -07002438- Serial Flash support
2439 CONFIG_CMD_SF
2440
2441 Defining this option enables SPI flash commands
2442 'sf probe/read/write/erase/update'.
2443
2444 Usage requires an initial 'probe' to define the serial
2445 flash parameters, followed by read/write/erase/update
2446 commands.
2447
2448 The following defaults may be provided by the platform
2449 to handle the common case when only a single serial
2450 flash is present on the system.
2451
2452 CONFIG_SF_DEFAULT_BUS Bus identifier
2453 CONFIG_SF_DEFAULT_CS Chip-select
2454 CONFIG_SF_DEFAULT_MODE (see include/spi.h)
2455 CONFIG_SF_DEFAULT_SPEED in Hz
2456
Simon Glass24007272012-10-08 13:16:02 +00002457 CONFIG_CMD_SF_TEST
2458
2459 Define this option to include a destructive SPI flash
2460 test ('sf test').
2461
wdenk3f85ce22004-02-23 16:11:30 +00002462- SystemACE Support:
2463 CONFIG_SYSTEMACE
2464
2465 Adding this option adds support for Xilinx SystemACE
2466 chips attached via some sort of local bus. The address
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02002467 of the chip must also be defined in the
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02002468 CONFIG_SYS_SYSTEMACE_BASE macro. For example:
wdenk3f85ce22004-02-23 16:11:30 +00002469
2470 #define CONFIG_SYSTEMACE
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02002471 #define CONFIG_SYS_SYSTEMACE_BASE 0xf0000000
wdenk3f85ce22004-02-23 16:11:30 +00002472
2473 When SystemACE support is added, the "ace" device type
2474 becomes available to the fat commands, i.e. fatls.
2475
Wolfgang Denkecb0ccd2005-09-24 22:37:32 +02002476- TFTP Fixed UDP Port:
2477 CONFIG_TFTP_PORT
2478
Wolfgang Denk28cb9372005-09-24 23:25:46 +02002479 If this is defined, the environment variable tftpsrcp
Wolfgang Denkecb0ccd2005-09-24 22:37:32 +02002480 is used to supply the TFTP UDP source port value.
Wolfgang Denk28cb9372005-09-24 23:25:46 +02002481 If tftpsrcp isn't defined, the normal pseudo-random port
Wolfgang Denkecb0ccd2005-09-24 22:37:32 +02002482 number generator is used.
2483
Wolfgang Denk28cb9372005-09-24 23:25:46 +02002484 Also, the environment variable tftpdstp is used to supply
2485 the TFTP UDP destination port value. If tftpdstp isn't
2486 defined, the normal port 69 is used.
2487
2488 The purpose for tftpsrcp is to allow a TFTP server to
Wolfgang Denkecb0ccd2005-09-24 22:37:32 +02002489 blindly start the TFTP transfer using the pre-configured
2490 target IP address and UDP port. This has the effect of
2491 "punching through" the (Windows XP) firewall, allowing
2492 the remainder of the TFTP transfer to proceed normally.
2493 A better solution is to properly configure the firewall,
2494 but sometimes that is not allowed.
2495
Simon Glassbf36c5d2012-12-05 14:46:38 +00002496- Hashing support:
2497 CONFIG_CMD_HASH
2498
2499 This enables a generic 'hash' command which can produce
2500 hashes / digests from a few algorithms (e.g. SHA1, SHA256).
2501
2502 CONFIG_HASH_VERIFY
2503
2504 Enable the hash verify command (hash -v). This adds to code
2505 size a little.
2506
2507 CONFIG_SHA1 - support SHA1 hashing
2508 CONFIG_SHA256 - support SHA256 hashing
2509
2510 Note: There is also a sha1sum command, which should perhaps
2511 be deprecated in favour of 'hash sha1'.
2512
wdenka8c7c702003-12-06 19:49:23 +00002513- Show boot progress:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002514 CONFIG_SHOW_BOOT_PROGRESS
2515
wdenk43d96162003-03-06 00:02:04 +00002516 Defining this option allows to add some board-
2517 specific code (calling a user-provided function
2518 "show_boot_progress(int)") that enables you to show
2519 the system's boot progress on some display (for
2520 example, some LED's) on your board. At the moment,
2521 the following checkpoints are implemented:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002522
Simon Glass3a608ca2012-02-13 13:51:19 +00002523- Detailed boot stage timing
2524 CONFIG_BOOTSTAGE
2525 Define this option to get detailed timing of each stage
2526 of the boot process.
2527
2528 CONFIG_BOOTSTAGE_USER_COUNT
2529 This is the number of available user bootstage records.
2530 Each time you call bootstage_mark(BOOTSTAGE_ID_ALLOC, ...)
2531 a new ID will be allocated from this stash. If you exceed
2532 the limit, recording will stop.
2533
2534 CONFIG_BOOTSTAGE_REPORT
2535 Define this to print a report before boot, similar to this:
2536
2537 Timer summary in microseconds:
2538 Mark Elapsed Stage
2539 0 0 reset
2540 3,575,678 3,575,678 board_init_f start
2541 3,575,695 17 arch_cpu_init A9
2542 3,575,777 82 arch_cpu_init done
2543 3,659,598 83,821 board_init_r start
2544 3,910,375 250,777 main_loop
2545 29,916,167 26,005,792 bootm_start
2546 30,361,327 445,160 start_kernel
2547
Simon Glass2eba38c2012-09-28 08:56:39 +00002548 CONFIG_CMD_BOOTSTAGE
2549 Add a 'bootstage' command which supports printing a report
2550 and un/stashing of bootstage data.
2551
Simon Glass94fd1312012-09-28 08:56:37 +00002552 CONFIG_BOOTSTAGE_FDT
2553 Stash the bootstage information in the FDT. A root 'bootstage'
2554 node is created with each bootstage id as a child. Each child
2555 has a 'name' property and either 'mark' containing the
2556 mark time in microsecond, or 'accum' containing the
2557 accumulated time for that bootstage id in microseconds.
2558 For example:
2559
2560 bootstage {
2561 154 {
2562 name = "board_init_f";
2563 mark = <3575678>;
2564 };
2565 170 {
2566 name = "lcd";
2567 accum = <33482>;
2568 };
2569 };
2570
2571 Code in the Linux kernel can find this in /proc/devicetree.
2572
Marian Balakowicz1372cce2008-03-12 10:33:01 +01002573Legacy uImage format:
2574
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002575 Arg Where When
2576 1 common/cmd_bootm.c before attempting to boot an image
wdenkba56f622004-02-06 23:19:44 +00002577 -1 common/cmd_bootm.c Image header has bad magic number
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002578 2 common/cmd_bootm.c Image header has correct magic number
wdenkba56f622004-02-06 23:19:44 +00002579 -2 common/cmd_bootm.c Image header has bad checksum
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002580 3 common/cmd_bootm.c Image header has correct checksum
wdenkba56f622004-02-06 23:19:44 +00002581 -3 common/cmd_bootm.c Image data has bad checksum
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002582 4 common/cmd_bootm.c Image data has correct checksum
2583 -4 common/cmd_bootm.c Image is for unsupported architecture
2584 5 common/cmd_bootm.c Architecture check OK
Marian Balakowicz1372cce2008-03-12 10:33:01 +01002585 -5 common/cmd_bootm.c Wrong Image Type (not kernel, multi)
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002586 6 common/cmd_bootm.c Image Type check OK
2587 -6 common/cmd_bootm.c gunzip uncompression error
2588 -7 common/cmd_bootm.c Unimplemented compression type
2589 7 common/cmd_bootm.c Uncompression OK
Marian Balakowicz1372cce2008-03-12 10:33:01 +01002590 8 common/cmd_bootm.c No uncompress/copy overwrite error
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002591 -9 common/cmd_bootm.c Unsupported OS (not Linux, BSD, VxWorks, QNX)
Marian Balakowicz1372cce2008-03-12 10:33:01 +01002592
2593 9 common/image.c Start initial ramdisk verification
2594 -10 common/image.c Ramdisk header has bad magic number
2595 -11 common/image.c Ramdisk header has bad checksum
2596 10 common/image.c Ramdisk header is OK
2597 -12 common/image.c Ramdisk data has bad checksum
2598 11 common/image.c Ramdisk data has correct checksum
2599 12 common/image.c Ramdisk verification complete, start loading
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02002600 -13 common/image.c Wrong Image Type (not PPC Linux ramdisk)
Marian Balakowicz1372cce2008-03-12 10:33:01 +01002601 13 common/image.c Start multifile image verification
2602 14 common/image.c No initial ramdisk, no multifile, continue.
2603
Wolfgang Denkc0f40852011-10-26 10:21:21 +00002604 15 arch/<arch>/lib/bootm.c All preparation done, transferring control to OS
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002605
Stefan Roesea47a12b2010-04-15 16:07:28 +02002606 -30 arch/powerpc/lib/board.c Fatal error, hang the system
wdenk11dadd52004-02-27 00:07:27 +00002607 -31 post/post.c POST test failed, detected by post_output_backlog()
2608 -32 post/post.c POST test failed, detected by post_run_single()
wdenk63e73c92004-02-23 22:22:28 +00002609
Heiko Schocher566a4942007-06-22 19:11:54 +02002610 34 common/cmd_doc.c before loading a Image from a DOC device
2611 -35 common/cmd_doc.c Bad usage of "doc" command
2612 35 common/cmd_doc.c correct usage of "doc" command
2613 -36 common/cmd_doc.c No boot device
2614 36 common/cmd_doc.c correct boot device
2615 -37 common/cmd_doc.c Unknown Chip ID on boot device
2616 37 common/cmd_doc.c correct chip ID found, device available
2617 -38 common/cmd_doc.c Read Error on boot device
2618 38 common/cmd_doc.c reading Image header from DOC device OK
2619 -39 common/cmd_doc.c Image header has bad magic number
2620 39 common/cmd_doc.c Image header has correct magic number
2621 -40 common/cmd_doc.c Error reading Image from DOC device
2622 40 common/cmd_doc.c Image header has correct magic number
2623 41 common/cmd_ide.c before loading a Image from a IDE device
2624 -42 common/cmd_ide.c Bad usage of "ide" command
2625 42 common/cmd_ide.c correct usage of "ide" command
2626 -43 common/cmd_ide.c No boot device
2627 43 common/cmd_ide.c boot device found
2628 -44 common/cmd_ide.c Device not available
2629 44 common/cmd_ide.c Device available
2630 -45 common/cmd_ide.c wrong partition selected
2631 45 common/cmd_ide.c partition selected
2632 -46 common/cmd_ide.c Unknown partition table
2633 46 common/cmd_ide.c valid partition table found
2634 -47 common/cmd_ide.c Invalid partition type
2635 47 common/cmd_ide.c correct partition type
2636 -48 common/cmd_ide.c Error reading Image Header on boot device
2637 48 common/cmd_ide.c reading Image Header from IDE device OK
2638 -49 common/cmd_ide.c Image header has bad magic number
2639 49 common/cmd_ide.c Image header has correct magic number
2640 -50 common/cmd_ide.c Image header has bad checksum
2641 50 common/cmd_ide.c Image header has correct checksum
2642 -51 common/cmd_ide.c Error reading Image from IDE device
2643 51 common/cmd_ide.c reading Image from IDE device OK
2644 52 common/cmd_nand.c before loading a Image from a NAND device
2645 -53 common/cmd_nand.c Bad usage of "nand" command
2646 53 common/cmd_nand.c correct usage of "nand" command
2647 -54 common/cmd_nand.c No boot device
2648 54 common/cmd_nand.c boot device found
2649 -55 common/cmd_nand.c Unknown Chip ID on boot device
2650 55 common/cmd_nand.c correct chip ID found, device available
2651 -56 common/cmd_nand.c Error reading Image Header on boot device
2652 56 common/cmd_nand.c reading Image Header from NAND device OK
2653 -57 common/cmd_nand.c Image header has bad magic number
2654 57 common/cmd_nand.c Image header has correct magic number
2655 -58 common/cmd_nand.c Error reading Image from NAND device
2656 58 common/cmd_nand.c reading Image from NAND device OK
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002657
Heiko Schocher566a4942007-06-22 19:11:54 +02002658 -60 common/env_common.c Environment has a bad CRC, using default
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002659
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02002660 64 net/eth.c starting with Ethernet configuration.
Heiko Schocher566a4942007-06-22 19:11:54 +02002661 -64 net/eth.c no Ethernet found.
2662 65 net/eth.c Ethernet found.
wdenk206c60c2003-09-18 10:02:25 +00002663
Heiko Schocher566a4942007-06-22 19:11:54 +02002664 -80 common/cmd_net.c usage wrong
2665 80 common/cmd_net.c before calling NetLoop()
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02002666 -81 common/cmd_net.c some error in NetLoop() occurred
Heiko Schocher566a4942007-06-22 19:11:54 +02002667 81 common/cmd_net.c NetLoop() back without error
2668 -82 common/cmd_net.c size == 0 (File with size 0 loaded)
2669 82 common/cmd_net.c trying automatic boot
Wolfgang Denk74de7ae2009-04-01 23:34:12 +02002670 83 common/cmd_net.c running "source" command
2671 -83 common/cmd_net.c some error in automatic boot or "source" command
Heiko Schocher566a4942007-06-22 19:11:54 +02002672 84 common/cmd_net.c end without errors
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002673
Marian Balakowicz1372cce2008-03-12 10:33:01 +01002674FIT uImage format:
2675
2676 Arg Where When
2677 100 common/cmd_bootm.c Kernel FIT Image has correct format
2678 -100 common/cmd_bootm.c Kernel FIT Image has incorrect format
2679 101 common/cmd_bootm.c No Kernel subimage unit name, using configuration
2680 -101 common/cmd_bootm.c Can't get configuration for kernel subimage
2681 102 common/cmd_bootm.c Kernel unit name specified
2682 -103 common/cmd_bootm.c Can't get kernel subimage node offset
Marian Balakowiczf773bea2008-03-12 10:35:46 +01002683 103 common/cmd_bootm.c Found configuration node
Marian Balakowicz1372cce2008-03-12 10:33:01 +01002684 104 common/cmd_bootm.c Got kernel subimage node offset
2685 -104 common/cmd_bootm.c Kernel subimage hash verification failed
2686 105 common/cmd_bootm.c Kernel subimage hash verification OK
2687 -105 common/cmd_bootm.c Kernel subimage is for unsupported architecture
2688 106 common/cmd_bootm.c Architecture check OK
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02002689 -106 common/cmd_bootm.c Kernel subimage has wrong type
2690 107 common/cmd_bootm.c Kernel subimage type OK
Marian Balakowicz1372cce2008-03-12 10:33:01 +01002691 -107 common/cmd_bootm.c Can't get kernel subimage data/size
2692 108 common/cmd_bootm.c Got kernel subimage data/size
2693 -108 common/cmd_bootm.c Wrong image type (not legacy, FIT)
2694 -109 common/cmd_bootm.c Can't get kernel subimage type
2695 -110 common/cmd_bootm.c Can't get kernel subimage comp
2696 -111 common/cmd_bootm.c Can't get kernel subimage os
2697 -112 common/cmd_bootm.c Can't get kernel subimage load address
2698 -113 common/cmd_bootm.c Image uncompress/copy overwrite error
2699
2700 120 common/image.c Start initial ramdisk verification
2701 -120 common/image.c Ramdisk FIT image has incorrect format
2702 121 common/image.c Ramdisk FIT image has correct format
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02002703 122 common/image.c No ramdisk subimage unit name, using configuration
Marian Balakowicz1372cce2008-03-12 10:33:01 +01002704 -122 common/image.c Can't get configuration for ramdisk subimage
2705 123 common/image.c Ramdisk unit name specified
2706 -124 common/image.c Can't get ramdisk subimage node offset
2707 125 common/image.c Got ramdisk subimage node offset
2708 -125 common/image.c Ramdisk subimage hash verification failed
2709 126 common/image.c Ramdisk subimage hash verification OK
2710 -126 common/image.c Ramdisk subimage for unsupported architecture
2711 127 common/image.c Architecture check OK
2712 -127 common/image.c Can't get ramdisk subimage data/size
2713 128 common/image.c Got ramdisk subimage data/size
2714 129 common/image.c Can't get ramdisk load address
2715 -129 common/image.c Got ramdisk load address
2716
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02002717 -130 common/cmd_doc.c Incorrect FIT image format
Marian Balakowicz1372cce2008-03-12 10:33:01 +01002718 131 common/cmd_doc.c FIT image format OK
2719
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02002720 -140 common/cmd_ide.c Incorrect FIT image format
Marian Balakowicz1372cce2008-03-12 10:33:01 +01002721 141 common/cmd_ide.c FIT image format OK
2722
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02002723 -150 common/cmd_nand.c Incorrect FIT image format
Marian Balakowicz1372cce2008-03-12 10:33:01 +01002724 151 common/cmd_nand.c FIT image format OK
2725
Gabe Blackd95f6ec2012-10-25 16:31:10 +00002726- FIT image support:
2727 CONFIG_FIT
2728 Enable support for the FIT uImage format.
2729
2730 CONFIG_FIT_BEST_MATCH
2731 When no configuration is explicitly selected, default to the
2732 one whose fdt's compatibility field best matches that of
2733 U-Boot itself. A match is considered "best" if it matches the
2734 most specific compatibility entry of U-Boot's fdt's root node.
2735 The order of entries in the configuration's fdt is ignored.
2736
Wolfgang Denk4cf26092011-10-07 09:58:21 +02002737- Standalone program support:
2738 CONFIG_STANDALONE_LOAD_ADDR
2739
Wolfgang Denk6feff892011-10-09 21:06:34 +02002740 This option defines a board specific value for the
2741 address where standalone program gets loaded, thus
2742 overwriting the architecture dependent default
Wolfgang Denk4cf26092011-10-07 09:58:21 +02002743 settings.
2744
2745- Frame Buffer Address:
2746 CONFIG_FB_ADDR
2747
2748 Define CONFIG_FB_ADDR if you want to use specific
Wolfgang Denk44a53b52013-01-03 00:43:59 +00002749 address for frame buffer. This is typically the case
2750 when using a graphics controller has separate video
2751 memory. U-Boot will then place the frame buffer at
2752 the given address instead of dynamically reserving it
2753 in system RAM by calling lcd_setmem(), which grabs
2754 the memory for the frame buffer depending on the
2755 configured panel size.
Wolfgang Denk4cf26092011-10-07 09:58:21 +02002756
2757 Please see board_init_f function.
2758
Detlev Zundelcccfc2a2009-12-01 17:16:19 +01002759- Automatic software updates via TFTP server
2760 CONFIG_UPDATE_TFTP
2761 CONFIG_UPDATE_TFTP_CNT_MAX
2762 CONFIG_UPDATE_TFTP_MSEC_MAX
2763
2764 These options enable and control the auto-update feature;
2765 for a more detailed description refer to doc/README.update.
2766
2767- MTD Support (mtdparts command, UBI support)
2768 CONFIG_MTD_DEVICE
2769
2770 Adds the MTD device infrastructure from the Linux kernel.
2771 Needed for mtdparts command support.
2772
2773 CONFIG_MTD_PARTITIONS
2774
2775 Adds the MTD partitioning infrastructure from the Linux
2776 kernel. Needed for UBI support.
2777
Daniel Schwierzeck6a11cf42011-07-18 07:48:07 +00002778- SPL framework
Wolfgang Denk04e5ae72011-09-11 21:24:09 +02002779 CONFIG_SPL
2780 Enable building of SPL globally.
Daniel Schwierzeck6a11cf42011-07-18 07:48:07 +00002781
Tom Rini95579792012-02-14 07:29:40 +00002782 CONFIG_SPL_LDSCRIPT
2783 LDSCRIPT for linking the SPL binary.
2784
2785 CONFIG_SPL_MAX_SIZE
2786 Maximum binary size (text, data and rodata) of the SPL binary.
2787
Wolfgang Denk04e5ae72011-09-11 21:24:09 +02002788 CONFIG_SPL_TEXT_BASE
2789 TEXT_BASE for linking the SPL binary.
Daniel Schwierzeck6a11cf42011-07-18 07:48:07 +00002790
Scott Wood94a45bb2012-09-20 19:05:12 -05002791 CONFIG_SPL_RELOC_TEXT_BASE
2792 Address to relocate to. If unspecified, this is equal to
2793 CONFIG_SPL_TEXT_BASE (i.e. no relocation is done).
2794
Tom Rini95579792012-02-14 07:29:40 +00002795 CONFIG_SPL_BSS_START_ADDR
2796 Link address for the BSS within the SPL binary.
2797
2798 CONFIG_SPL_BSS_MAX_SIZE
2799 Maximum binary size of the BSS section of the SPL binary.
2800
2801 CONFIG_SPL_STACK
2802 Adress of the start of the stack SPL will use
2803
Scott Wood94a45bb2012-09-20 19:05:12 -05002804 CONFIG_SPL_RELOC_STACK
2805 Adress of the start of the stack SPL will use after
2806 relocation. If unspecified, this is equal to
2807 CONFIG_SPL_STACK.
2808
Tom Rini95579792012-02-14 07:29:40 +00002809 CONFIG_SYS_SPL_MALLOC_START
2810 Starting address of the malloc pool used in SPL.
2811
2812 CONFIG_SYS_SPL_MALLOC_SIZE
2813 The size of the malloc pool used in SPL.
Daniel Schwierzeck6a11cf42011-07-18 07:48:07 +00002814
Tom Rini47f7bca2012-08-13 12:03:19 -07002815 CONFIG_SPL_FRAMEWORK
2816 Enable the SPL framework under common/. This framework
2817 supports MMC, NAND and YMODEM loading of U-Boot and NAND
2818 NAND loading of the Linux Kernel.
2819
Tom Rini861a86f2012-08-13 11:37:56 -07002820 CONFIG_SPL_DISPLAY_PRINT
2821 For ARM, enable an optional function to print more information
2822 about the running system.
2823
Scott Wood4b919722012-09-20 16:35:21 -05002824 CONFIG_SPL_INIT_MINIMAL
2825 Arch init code should be built for a very small image
2826
Wolfgang Denk04e5ae72011-09-11 21:24:09 +02002827 CONFIG_SPL_LIBCOMMON_SUPPORT
2828 Support for common/libcommon.o in SPL binary
Daniel Schwierzeck6a11cf42011-07-18 07:48:07 +00002829
Wolfgang Denk04e5ae72011-09-11 21:24:09 +02002830 CONFIG_SPL_LIBDISK_SUPPORT
2831 Support for disk/libdisk.o in SPL binary
Daniel Schwierzeck6a11cf42011-07-18 07:48:07 +00002832
Wolfgang Denk04e5ae72011-09-11 21:24:09 +02002833 CONFIG_SPL_I2C_SUPPORT
2834 Support for drivers/i2c/libi2c.o in SPL binary
Daniel Schwierzeck6a11cf42011-07-18 07:48:07 +00002835
Wolfgang Denk04e5ae72011-09-11 21:24:09 +02002836 CONFIG_SPL_GPIO_SUPPORT
2837 Support for drivers/gpio/libgpio.o in SPL binary
Daniel Schwierzeck6a11cf42011-07-18 07:48:07 +00002838
Wolfgang Denk04e5ae72011-09-11 21:24:09 +02002839 CONFIG_SPL_MMC_SUPPORT
2840 Support for drivers/mmc/libmmc.o in SPL binary
Daniel Schwierzeck6a11cf42011-07-18 07:48:07 +00002841
Tom Rini95579792012-02-14 07:29:40 +00002842 CONFIG_SYS_MMCSD_RAW_MODE_U_BOOT_SECTOR,
2843 CONFIG_SYS_U_BOOT_MAX_SIZE_SECTORS,
2844 CONFIG_SYS_MMC_SD_FAT_BOOT_PARTITION
2845 Address, size and partition on the MMC to load U-Boot from
2846 when the MMC is being used in raw mode.
2847
2848 CONFIG_SPL_FAT_SUPPORT
2849 Support for fs/fat/libfat.o in SPL binary
2850
2851 CONFIG_SPL_FAT_LOAD_PAYLOAD_NAME
2852 Filename to read to load U-Boot when reading from FAT
2853
Scott Wood06f60ae2012-12-06 13:33:17 +00002854 CONFIG_SPL_MPC83XX_WAIT_FOR_NAND
2855 Set this for NAND SPL on PPC mpc83xx targets, so that
2856 start.S waits for the rest of the SPL to load before
2857 continuing (the hardware starts execution after just
2858 loading the first page rather than the full 4K).
2859
Scott Wood6f2f01b2012-09-20 19:09:07 -05002860 CONFIG_SPL_NAND_BASE
2861 Include nand_base.c in the SPL. Requires
2862 CONFIG_SPL_NAND_DRIVERS.
2863
2864 CONFIG_SPL_NAND_DRIVERS
2865 SPL uses normal NAND drivers, not minimal drivers.
2866
2867 CONFIG_SPL_NAND_ECC
2868 Include standard software ECC in the SPL
2869
Tom Rini95579792012-02-14 07:29:40 +00002870 CONFIG_SPL_NAND_SIMPLE
Scott Wood7d4b7952012-09-21 18:35:27 -05002871 Support for NAND boot using simple NAND drivers that
2872 expose the cmd_ctrl() interface.
Tom Rini95579792012-02-14 07:29:40 +00002873
2874 CONFIG_SYS_NAND_5_ADDR_CYCLE, CONFIG_SYS_NAND_PAGE_COUNT,
2875 CONFIG_SYS_NAND_PAGE_SIZE, CONFIG_SYS_NAND_OOBSIZE,
2876 CONFIG_SYS_NAND_BLOCK_SIZE, CONFIG_SYS_NAND_BAD_BLOCK_POS,
2877 CONFIG_SYS_NAND_ECCPOS, CONFIG_SYS_NAND_ECCSIZE,
2878 CONFIG_SYS_NAND_ECCBYTES
2879 Defines the size and behavior of the NAND that SPL uses
Scott Wood7d4b7952012-09-21 18:35:27 -05002880 to read U-Boot
Tom Rini95579792012-02-14 07:29:40 +00002881
2882 CONFIG_SYS_NAND_U_BOOT_OFFS
Scott Wood7d4b7952012-09-21 18:35:27 -05002883 Location in NAND to read U-Boot from
2884
2885 CONFIG_SYS_NAND_U_BOOT_DST
2886 Location in memory to load U-Boot to
2887
2888 CONFIG_SYS_NAND_U_BOOT_SIZE
2889 Size of image to load
Tom Rini95579792012-02-14 07:29:40 +00002890
2891 CONFIG_SYS_NAND_U_BOOT_START
Scott Wood7d4b7952012-09-21 18:35:27 -05002892 Entry point in loaded image to jump to
Tom Rini95579792012-02-14 07:29:40 +00002893
2894 CONFIG_SYS_NAND_HW_ECC_OOBFIRST
2895 Define this if you need to first read the OOB and then the
2896 data. This is used for example on davinci plattforms.
2897
2898 CONFIG_SPL_OMAP3_ID_NAND
2899 Support for an OMAP3-specific set of functions to return the
2900 ID and MFR of the first attached NAND chip, if present.
2901
Wolfgang Denk04e5ae72011-09-11 21:24:09 +02002902 CONFIG_SPL_SERIAL_SUPPORT
2903 Support for drivers/serial/libserial.o in SPL binary
Daniel Schwierzeck6a11cf42011-07-18 07:48:07 +00002904
Wolfgang Denk04e5ae72011-09-11 21:24:09 +02002905 CONFIG_SPL_SPI_FLASH_SUPPORT
2906 Support for drivers/mtd/spi/libspi_flash.o in SPL binary
Daniel Schwierzeck6a11cf42011-07-18 07:48:07 +00002907
Wolfgang Denk04e5ae72011-09-11 21:24:09 +02002908 CONFIG_SPL_SPI_SUPPORT
2909 Support for drivers/spi/libspi.o in SPL binary
Daniel Schwierzeck6a11cf42011-07-18 07:48:07 +00002910
Pavel Machekc57b9532012-08-30 22:42:11 +02002911 CONFIG_SPL_RAM_DEVICE
2912 Support for running image already present in ram, in SPL binary
2913
Wolfgang Denk04e5ae72011-09-11 21:24:09 +02002914 CONFIG_SPL_LIBGENERIC_SUPPORT
2915 Support for lib/libgeneric.o in SPL binary
Marian Balakowicz1372cce2008-03-12 10:33:01 +01002916
Scott Wood74752ba2012-12-06 13:33:16 +00002917 CONFIG_SPL_PAD_TO
2918 Linker address to which the SPL should be padded before
2919 appending the SPL payload.
2920
Scott Woodca2fca22012-09-21 16:27:32 -05002921 CONFIG_SPL_TARGET
2922 Final target image containing SPL and payload. Some SPLs
2923 use an arch-specific makefile fragment instead, for
2924 example if more than one image needs to be produced.
2925
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002926Modem Support:
2927--------------
2928
Wolfgang Denk566e5cf2011-05-01 20:44:23 +02002929[so far only for SMDK2400 boards]
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002930
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02002931- Modem support enable:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002932 CONFIG_MODEM_SUPPORT
2933
2934- RTS/CTS Flow control enable:
2935 CONFIG_HWFLOW
2936
2937- Modem debug support:
2938 CONFIG_MODEM_SUPPORT_DEBUG
2939
wdenk43d96162003-03-06 00:02:04 +00002940 Enables debugging stuff (char screen[1024], dbg())
2941 for modem support. Useful only with BDI2000.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002942
wdenka8c7c702003-12-06 19:49:23 +00002943- Interrupt support (PPC):
2944
wdenkd4ca31c2004-01-02 14:00:00 +00002945 There are common interrupt_init() and timer_interrupt()
2946 for all PPC archs. interrupt_init() calls interrupt_init_cpu()
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02002947 for CPU specific initialization. interrupt_init_cpu()
wdenkd4ca31c2004-01-02 14:00:00 +00002948 should set decrementer_count to appropriate value. If
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02002949 CPU resets decrementer automatically after interrupt
wdenkd4ca31c2004-01-02 14:00:00 +00002950 (ppc4xx) it should set decrementer_count to zero.
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02002951 timer_interrupt() calls timer_interrupt_cpu() for CPU
wdenkd4ca31c2004-01-02 14:00:00 +00002952 specific handling. If board has watchdog / status_led
2953 / other_activity_monitor it works automatically from
2954 general timer_interrupt().
wdenka8c7c702003-12-06 19:49:23 +00002955
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002956- General:
2957
wdenk43d96162003-03-06 00:02:04 +00002958 In the target system modem support is enabled when a
2959 specific key (key combination) is pressed during
2960 power-on. Otherwise U-Boot will boot normally
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02002961 (autoboot). The key_pressed() function is called from
wdenk43d96162003-03-06 00:02:04 +00002962 board_init(). Currently key_pressed() is a dummy
2963 function, returning 1 and thus enabling modem
2964 initialization.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002965
wdenk43d96162003-03-06 00:02:04 +00002966 If there are no modem init strings in the
2967 environment, U-Boot proceed to autoboot; the
2968 previous output (banner, info printfs) will be
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02002969 suppressed, though.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002970
2971 See also: doc/README.Modem
2972
Helmut Raiger9660e442011-10-20 04:19:47 +00002973Board initialization settings:
2974------------------------------
2975
2976During Initialization u-boot calls a number of board specific functions
2977to allow the preparation of board specific prerequisites, e.g. pin setup
2978before drivers are initialized. To enable these callbacks the
2979following configuration macros have to be defined. Currently this is
2980architecture specific, so please check arch/your_architecture/lib/board.c
2981typically in board_init_f() and board_init_r().
2982
2983- CONFIG_BOARD_EARLY_INIT_F: Call board_early_init_f()
2984- CONFIG_BOARD_EARLY_INIT_R: Call board_early_init_r()
2985- CONFIG_BOARD_LATE_INIT: Call board_late_init()
2986- CONFIG_BOARD_POSTCLK_INIT: Call board_postclk_init()
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002987
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002988Configuration Settings:
2989-----------------------
2990
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02002991- CONFIG_SYS_LONGHELP: Defined when you want long help messages included;
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002992 undefine this when you're short of memory.
2993
Peter Tyser2fb26042009-01-27 18:03:12 -06002994- CONFIG_SYS_HELP_CMD_WIDTH: Defined when you want to override the default
2995 width of the commands listed in the 'help' command output.
2996
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02002997- CONFIG_SYS_PROMPT: This is what U-Boot prints on the console to
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00002998 prompt for user input.
2999
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003000- CONFIG_SYS_CBSIZE: Buffer size for input from the Console
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003001
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003002- CONFIG_SYS_PBSIZE: Buffer size for Console output
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003003
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003004- CONFIG_SYS_MAXARGS: max. Number of arguments accepted for monitor commands
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003005
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003006- CONFIG_SYS_BARGSIZE: Buffer size for Boot Arguments which are passed to
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003007 the application (usually a Linux kernel) when it is
3008 booted
3009
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003010- CONFIG_SYS_BAUDRATE_TABLE:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003011 List of legal baudrate settings for this board.
3012
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003013- CONFIG_SYS_CONSOLE_INFO_QUIET
wdenk8bde7f72003-06-27 21:31:46 +00003014 Suppress display of console information at boot.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003015
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003016- CONFIG_SYS_CONSOLE_IS_IN_ENV
wdenk8bde7f72003-06-27 21:31:46 +00003017 If the board specific function
3018 extern int overwrite_console (void);
3019 returns 1, the stdin, stderr and stdout are switched to the
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003020 serial port, else the settings in the environment are used.
3021
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003022- CONFIG_SYS_CONSOLE_OVERWRITE_ROUTINE
wdenk8bde7f72003-06-27 21:31:46 +00003023 Enable the call to overwrite_console().
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003024
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003025- CONFIG_SYS_CONSOLE_ENV_OVERWRITE
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003026 Enable overwrite of previous console environment settings.
3027
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003028- CONFIG_SYS_MEMTEST_START, CONFIG_SYS_MEMTEST_END:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003029 Begin and End addresses of the area used by the
3030 simple memory test.
3031
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003032- CONFIG_SYS_ALT_MEMTEST:
wdenk8bde7f72003-06-27 21:31:46 +00003033 Enable an alternate, more extensive memory test.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003034
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003035- CONFIG_SYS_MEMTEST_SCRATCH:
wdenk5f535fe2003-09-18 09:21:33 +00003036 Scratch address used by the alternate memory test
3037 You only need to set this if address zero isn't writeable
3038
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003039- CONFIG_SYS_MEM_TOP_HIDE (PPC only):
3040 If CONFIG_SYS_MEM_TOP_HIDE is defined in the board config header,
Stefan Roese14f73ca2008-03-26 10:14:11 +01003041 this specified memory area will get subtracted from the top
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02003042 (end) of RAM and won't get "touched" at all by U-Boot. By
Stefan Roese14f73ca2008-03-26 10:14:11 +01003043 fixing up gd->ram_size the Linux kernel should gets passed
3044 the now "corrected" memory size and won't touch it either.
3045 This should work for arch/ppc and arch/powerpc. Only Linux
Stefan Roese5e12e752008-03-28 11:02:53 +01003046 board ports in arch/powerpc with bootwrapper support that
Stefan Roese14f73ca2008-03-26 10:14:11 +01003047 recalculate the memory size from the SDRAM controller setup
Stefan Roese5e12e752008-03-28 11:02:53 +01003048 will have to get fixed in Linux additionally.
Stefan Roese14f73ca2008-03-26 10:14:11 +01003049
3050 This option can be used as a workaround for the 440EPx/GRx
3051 CHIP 11 errata where the last 256 bytes in SDRAM shouldn't
3052 be touched.
3053
3054 WARNING: Please make sure that this value is a multiple of
3055 the Linux page size (normally 4k). If this is not the case,
3056 then the end address of the Linux memory will be located at a
3057 non page size aligned address and this could cause major
3058 problems.
3059
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003060- CONFIG_SYS_LOADS_BAUD_CHANGE:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003061 Enable temporary baudrate change while serial download
3062
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003063- CONFIG_SYS_SDRAM_BASE:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003064 Physical start address of SDRAM. _Must_ be 0 here.
3065
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003066- CONFIG_SYS_MBIO_BASE:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003067 Physical start address of Motherboard I/O (if using a
3068 Cogent motherboard)
3069
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003070- CONFIG_SYS_FLASH_BASE:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003071 Physical start address of Flash memory.
3072
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003073- CONFIG_SYS_MONITOR_BASE:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003074 Physical start address of boot monitor code (set by
3075 make config files to be same as the text base address
Wolfgang Denk14d0a022010-10-07 21:51:12 +02003076 (CONFIG_SYS_TEXT_BASE) used when linking) - same as
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003077 CONFIG_SYS_FLASH_BASE when booting from flash.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003078
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003079- CONFIG_SYS_MONITOR_LEN:
wdenk8bde7f72003-06-27 21:31:46 +00003080 Size of memory reserved for monitor code, used to
3081 determine _at_compile_time_ (!) if the environment is
3082 embedded within the U-Boot image, or in a separate
3083 flash sector.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003084
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003085- CONFIG_SYS_MALLOC_LEN:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003086 Size of DRAM reserved for malloc() use.
3087
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003088- CONFIG_SYS_BOOTM_LEN:
Stefan Roese15940c92006-03-13 11:16:36 +01003089 Normally compressed uImages are limited to an
3090 uncompressed size of 8 MBytes. If this is not enough,
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003091 you can define CONFIG_SYS_BOOTM_LEN in your board config file
Stefan Roese15940c92006-03-13 11:16:36 +01003092 to adjust this setting to your needs.
3093
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003094- CONFIG_SYS_BOOTMAPSZ:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003095 Maximum size of memory mapped by the startup code of
3096 the Linux kernel; all data that must be processed by
Bartlomiej Sieka7d721e32008-04-14 15:44:16 +02003097 the Linux kernel (bd_info, boot arguments, FDT blob if
3098 used) must be put below this limit, unless "bootm_low"
3099 enviroment variable is defined and non-zero. In such case
3100 all data for the Linux kernel must be between "bootm_low"
Wolfgang Denkc0f40852011-10-26 10:21:21 +00003101 and "bootm_low" + CONFIG_SYS_BOOTMAPSZ. The environment
Grant Likelyc3624e62011-03-28 09:58:43 +00003102 variable "bootm_mapsize" will override the value of
3103 CONFIG_SYS_BOOTMAPSZ. If CONFIG_SYS_BOOTMAPSZ is undefined,
3104 then the value in "bootm_size" will be used instead.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003105
John Rigbyfca43cc2010-10-13 13:57:35 -06003106- CONFIG_SYS_BOOT_RAMDISK_HIGH:
3107 Enable initrd_high functionality. If defined then the
3108 initrd_high feature is enabled and the bootm ramdisk subcommand
3109 is enabled.
3110
3111- CONFIG_SYS_BOOT_GET_CMDLINE:
3112 Enables allocating and saving kernel cmdline in space between
3113 "bootm_low" and "bootm_low" + BOOTMAPSZ.
3114
3115- CONFIG_SYS_BOOT_GET_KBD:
3116 Enables allocating and saving a kernel copy of the bd_info in
3117 space between "bootm_low" and "bootm_low" + BOOTMAPSZ.
3118
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003119- CONFIG_SYS_MAX_FLASH_BANKS:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003120 Max number of Flash memory banks
3121
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003122- CONFIG_SYS_MAX_FLASH_SECT:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003123 Max number of sectors on a Flash chip
3124
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003125- CONFIG_SYS_FLASH_ERASE_TOUT:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003126 Timeout for Flash erase operations (in ms)
3127
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003128- CONFIG_SYS_FLASH_WRITE_TOUT:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003129 Timeout for Flash write operations (in ms)
3130
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003131- CONFIG_SYS_FLASH_LOCK_TOUT
wdenk8564acf2003-07-14 22:13:32 +00003132 Timeout for Flash set sector lock bit operation (in ms)
3133
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003134- CONFIG_SYS_FLASH_UNLOCK_TOUT
wdenk8564acf2003-07-14 22:13:32 +00003135 Timeout for Flash clear lock bits operation (in ms)
3136
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003137- CONFIG_SYS_FLASH_PROTECTION
wdenk8564acf2003-07-14 22:13:32 +00003138 If defined, hardware flash sectors protection is used
3139 instead of U-Boot software protection.
3140
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003141- CONFIG_SYS_DIRECT_FLASH_TFTP:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003142
3143 Enable TFTP transfers directly to flash memory;
3144 without this option such a download has to be
3145 performed in two steps: (1) download to RAM, and (2)
3146 copy from RAM to flash.
3147
3148 The two-step approach is usually more reliable, since
3149 you can check if the download worked before you erase
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02003150 the flash, but in some situations (when system RAM is
3151 too limited to allow for a temporary copy of the
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003152 downloaded image) this option may be very useful.
3153
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003154- CONFIG_SYS_FLASH_CFI:
wdenk43d96162003-03-06 00:02:04 +00003155 Define if the flash driver uses extra elements in the
wdenk5653fc32004-02-08 22:55:38 +00003156 common flash structure for storing flash geometry.
3157
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD00b18832008-08-13 01:40:42 +02003158- CONFIG_FLASH_CFI_DRIVER
wdenk5653fc32004-02-08 22:55:38 +00003159 This option also enables the building of the cfi_flash driver
3160 in the drivers directory
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003161
Piotr Ziecik91809ed2008-11-17 15:57:58 +01003162- CONFIG_FLASH_CFI_MTD
3163 This option enables the building of the cfi_mtd driver
3164 in the drivers directory. The driver exports CFI flash
3165 to the MTD layer.
3166
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003167- CONFIG_SYS_FLASH_USE_BUFFER_WRITE
Guennadi Liakhovetski96ef8312008-04-03 13:36:02 +02003168 Use buffered writes to flash.
3169
3170- CONFIG_FLASH_SPANSION_S29WS_N
3171 s29ws-n MirrorBit flash has non-standard addresses for buffered
3172 write commands.
3173
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003174- CONFIG_SYS_FLASH_QUIET_TEST
Stefan Roese5568e612005-11-22 13:20:42 +01003175 If this option is defined, the common CFI flash doesn't
3176 print it's warning upon not recognized FLASH banks. This
3177 is useful, if some of the configured banks are only
3178 optionally available.
3179
Jerry Van Baren9a042e92008-03-08 13:48:01 -05003180- CONFIG_FLASH_SHOW_PROGRESS
3181 If defined (must be an integer), print out countdown
3182 digits and dots. Recommended value: 45 (9..1) for 80
3183 column displays, 15 (3..1) for 40 column displays.
3184
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003185- CONFIG_SYS_RX_ETH_BUFFER:
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02003186 Defines the number of Ethernet receive buffers. On some
3187 Ethernet controllers it is recommended to set this value
stroese53cf9432003-06-05 15:39:44 +00003188 to 8 or even higher (EEPRO100 or 405 EMAC), since all
3189 buffers can be full shortly after enabling the interface
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02003190 on high Ethernet traffic.
stroese53cf9432003-06-05 15:39:44 +00003191 Defaults to 4 if not defined.
3192
Wolfgang Denkea882ba2010-06-20 23:33:59 +02003193- CONFIG_ENV_MAX_ENTRIES
3194
Wolfgang Denk071bc922010-10-27 22:48:30 +02003195 Maximum number of entries in the hash table that is used
3196 internally to store the environment settings. The default
3197 setting is supposed to be generous and should work in most
3198 cases. This setting can be used to tune behaviour; see
3199 lib/hashtable.c for details.
Wolfgang Denkea882ba2010-06-20 23:33:59 +02003200
Joe Hershberger25980902012-12-11 22:16:31 -06003201- CONFIG_ENV_FLAGS_LIST_DEFAULT
3202- CONFIG_ENV_FLAGS_LIST_STATIC
3203 Enable validation of the values given to enviroment variables when
3204 calling env set. Variables can be restricted to only decimal,
3205 hexadecimal, or boolean. If CONFIG_CMD_NET is also defined,
3206 the variables can also be restricted to IP address or MAC address.
3207
3208 The format of the list is:
3209 type_attribute = [s|d|x|b|i|m]
Joe Hershberger267541f2012-12-11 22:16:34 -06003210 access_atribute = [a|r|o|c]
3211 attributes = type_attribute[access_atribute]
Joe Hershberger25980902012-12-11 22:16:31 -06003212 entry = variable_name[:attributes]
3213 list = entry[,list]
3214
3215 The type attributes are:
3216 s - String (default)
3217 d - Decimal
3218 x - Hexadecimal
3219 b - Boolean ([1yYtT|0nNfF])
3220 i - IP address
3221 m - MAC address
3222
Joe Hershberger267541f2012-12-11 22:16:34 -06003223 The access attributes are:
3224 a - Any (default)
3225 r - Read-only
3226 o - Write-once
3227 c - Change-default
3228
Joe Hershberger25980902012-12-11 22:16:31 -06003229 - CONFIG_ENV_FLAGS_LIST_DEFAULT
3230 Define this to a list (string) to define the ".flags"
3231 envirnoment variable in the default or embedded environment.
3232
3233 - CONFIG_ENV_FLAGS_LIST_STATIC
3234 Define this to a list (string) to define validation that
3235 should be done if an entry is not found in the ".flags"
3236 environment variable. To override a setting in the static
3237 list, simply add an entry for the same variable name to the
3238 ".flags" variable.
3239
Joe Hershberger267541f2012-12-11 22:16:34 -06003240- CONFIG_ENV_ACCESS_IGNORE_FORCE
3241 If defined, don't allow the -f switch to env set override variable
3242 access flags.
3243
Simon Glass5c1a7ea2013-03-08 13:45:27 +00003244- CONFIG_SYS_GENERIC_BOARD
3245 This selects the architecture-generic board system instead of the
3246 architecture-specific board files. It is intended to move boards
3247 to this new framework over time. Defining this will disable the
3248 arch/foo/lib/board.c file and use common/board_f.c and
3249 common/board_r.c instead. To use this option your architecture
3250 must support it (i.e. must define __HAVE_ARCH_GENERIC_BOARD in
3251 its config.mk file). If you find problems enabling this option on
3252 your board please report the problem and send patches!
3253
Simon Glass632efa72013-03-11 07:06:48 +00003254- CONFIG_SYS_SYM_OFFSETS
3255 This is set by architectures that use offsets for link symbols
3256 instead of absolute values. So bss_start is obtained using an
3257 offset _bss_start_ofs from CONFIG_SYS_TEXT_BASE, rather than
3258 directly. You should not need to touch this setting.
3259
3260
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003261The following definitions that deal with the placement and management
3262of environment data (variable area); in general, we support the
3263following configurations:
3264
Mike Frysingerc3eb3fe2011-07-08 10:44:25 +00003265- CONFIG_BUILD_ENVCRC:
3266
3267 Builds up envcrc with the target environment so that external utils
3268 may easily extract it and embed it in final U-Boot images.
3269
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD5a1aceb2008-09-10 22:48:04 +02003270- CONFIG_ENV_IS_IN_FLASH:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003271
3272 Define this if the environment is in flash memory.
3273
3274 a) The environment occupies one whole flash sector, which is
3275 "embedded" in the text segment with the U-Boot code. This
3276 happens usually with "bottom boot sector" or "top boot
3277 sector" type flash chips, which have several smaller
3278 sectors at the start or the end. For instance, such a
3279 layout can have sector sizes of 8, 2x4, 16, Nx32 kB. In
3280 such a case you would place the environment in one of the
3281 4 kB sectors - with U-Boot code before and after it. With
3282 "top boot sector" type flash chips, you would put the
3283 environment in one of the last sectors, leaving a gap
3284 between U-Boot and the environment.
3285
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD0e8d1582008-09-10 22:48:06 +02003286 - CONFIG_ENV_OFFSET:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003287
3288 Offset of environment data (variable area) to the
3289 beginning of flash memory; for instance, with bottom boot
3290 type flash chips the second sector can be used: the offset
3291 for this sector is given here.
3292
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003293 CONFIG_ENV_OFFSET is used relative to CONFIG_SYS_FLASH_BASE.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003294
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD0e8d1582008-09-10 22:48:06 +02003295 - CONFIG_ENV_ADDR:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003296
3297 This is just another way to specify the start address of
3298 the flash sector containing the environment (instead of
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD0e8d1582008-09-10 22:48:06 +02003299 CONFIG_ENV_OFFSET).
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003300
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD0e8d1582008-09-10 22:48:06 +02003301 - CONFIG_ENV_SECT_SIZE:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003302
3303 Size of the sector containing the environment.
3304
3305
3306 b) Sometimes flash chips have few, equal sized, BIG sectors.
3307 In such a case you don't want to spend a whole sector for
3308 the environment.
3309
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD0e8d1582008-09-10 22:48:06 +02003310 - CONFIG_ENV_SIZE:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003311
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD5a1aceb2008-09-10 22:48:04 +02003312 If you use this in combination with CONFIG_ENV_IS_IN_FLASH
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD0e8d1582008-09-10 22:48:06 +02003313 and CONFIG_ENV_SECT_SIZE, you can specify to use only a part
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003314 of this flash sector for the environment. This saves
3315 memory for the RAM copy of the environment.
3316
3317 It may also save flash memory if you decide to use this
3318 when your environment is "embedded" within U-Boot code,
3319 since then the remainder of the flash sector could be used
3320 for U-Boot code. It should be pointed out that this is
3321 STRONGLY DISCOURAGED from a robustness point of view:
3322 updating the environment in flash makes it always
3323 necessary to erase the WHOLE sector. If something goes
3324 wrong before the contents has been restored from a copy in
3325 RAM, your target system will be dead.
3326
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD0e8d1582008-09-10 22:48:06 +02003327 - CONFIG_ENV_ADDR_REDUND
3328 CONFIG_ENV_SIZE_REDUND
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003329
wdenk43d96162003-03-06 00:02:04 +00003330 These settings describe a second storage area used to hold
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02003331 a redundant copy of the environment data, so that there is
wdenk3e386912003-04-05 00:53:31 +00003332 a valid backup copy in case there is a power failure during
wdenk43d96162003-03-06 00:02:04 +00003333 a "saveenv" operation.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003334
3335BE CAREFUL! Any changes to the flash layout, and some changes to the
3336source code will make it necessary to adapt <board>/u-boot.lds*
3337accordingly!
3338
3339
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD9314cee2008-09-10 22:47:59 +02003340- CONFIG_ENV_IS_IN_NVRAM:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003341
3342 Define this if you have some non-volatile memory device
3343 (NVRAM, battery buffered SRAM) which you want to use for the
3344 environment.
3345
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD0e8d1582008-09-10 22:48:06 +02003346 - CONFIG_ENV_ADDR:
3347 - CONFIG_ENV_SIZE:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003348
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02003349 These two #defines are used to determine the memory area you
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003350 want to use for environment. It is assumed that this memory
3351 can just be read and written to, without any special
3352 provision.
3353
3354BE CAREFUL! The first access to the environment happens quite early
3355in U-Boot initalization (when we try to get the setting of for the
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02003356console baudrate). You *MUST* have mapped your NVRAM area then, or
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003357U-Boot will hang.
3358
3359Please note that even with NVRAM we still use a copy of the
3360environment in RAM: we could work on NVRAM directly, but we want to
3361keep settings there always unmodified except somebody uses "saveenv"
3362to save the current settings.
3363
3364
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARDbb1f8b42008-09-05 09:19:30 +02003365- CONFIG_ENV_IS_IN_EEPROM:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003366
3367 Use this if you have an EEPROM or similar serial access
3368 device and a driver for it.
3369
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD0e8d1582008-09-10 22:48:06 +02003370 - CONFIG_ENV_OFFSET:
3371 - CONFIG_ENV_SIZE:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003372
3373 These two #defines specify the offset and size of the
3374 environment area within the total memory of your EEPROM.
3375
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003376 - CONFIG_SYS_I2C_EEPROM_ADDR:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003377 If defined, specified the chip address of the EEPROM device.
3378 The default address is zero.
3379
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003380 - CONFIG_SYS_EEPROM_PAGE_WRITE_BITS:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003381 If defined, the number of bits used to address bytes in a
3382 single page in the EEPROM device. A 64 byte page, for example
3383 would require six bits.
3384
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003385 - CONFIG_SYS_EEPROM_PAGE_WRITE_DELAY_MS:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003386 If defined, the number of milliseconds to delay between
wdenkba56f622004-02-06 23:19:44 +00003387 page writes. The default is zero milliseconds.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003388
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003389 - CONFIG_SYS_I2C_EEPROM_ADDR_LEN:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003390 The length in bytes of the EEPROM memory array address. Note
3391 that this is NOT the chip address length!
3392
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003393 - CONFIG_SYS_I2C_EEPROM_ADDR_OVERFLOW:
wdenk5cf91d62004-04-23 20:32:05 +00003394 EEPROM chips that implement "address overflow" are ones
3395 like Catalyst 24WC04/08/16 which has 9/10/11 bits of
3396 address and the extra bits end up in the "chip address" bit
3397 slots. This makes a 24WC08 (1Kbyte) chip look like four 256
3398 byte chips.
3399
3400 Note that we consider the length of the address field to
3401 still be one byte because the extra address bits are hidden
3402 in the chip address.
3403
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003404 - CONFIG_SYS_EEPROM_SIZE:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003405 The size in bytes of the EEPROM device.
3406
Heiko Schocher548738b2010-01-07 08:55:40 +01003407 - CONFIG_ENV_EEPROM_IS_ON_I2C
3408 define this, if you have I2C and SPI activated, and your
3409 EEPROM, which holds the environment, is on the I2C bus.
3410
3411 - CONFIG_I2C_ENV_EEPROM_BUS
3412 if you have an Environment on an EEPROM reached over
3413 I2C muxes, you can define here, how to reach this
3414 EEPROM. For example:
3415
Wolfgang Denka9046b92010-06-13 17:48:15 +02003416 #define CONFIG_I2C_ENV_EEPROM_BUS "pca9547:70:d\0"
Heiko Schocher548738b2010-01-07 08:55:40 +01003417
3418 EEPROM which holds the environment, is reached over
3419 a pca9547 i2c mux with address 0x70, channel 3.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003420
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD057c8492008-09-10 22:47:58 +02003421- CONFIG_ENV_IS_IN_DATAFLASH:
wdenk5779d8d2003-12-06 23:55:10 +00003422
wdenkd4ca31c2004-01-02 14:00:00 +00003423 Define this if you have a DataFlash memory device which you
wdenk5779d8d2003-12-06 23:55:10 +00003424 want to use for the environment.
3425
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD0e8d1582008-09-10 22:48:06 +02003426 - CONFIG_ENV_OFFSET:
3427 - CONFIG_ENV_ADDR:
3428 - CONFIG_ENV_SIZE:
wdenk5779d8d2003-12-06 23:55:10 +00003429
3430 These three #defines specify the offset and size of the
3431 environment area within the total memory of your DataFlash placed
3432 at the specified address.
3433
Liu Gang0a85a9e2012-03-08 00:33:20 +00003434- CONFIG_ENV_IS_IN_REMOTE:
3435
3436 Define this if you have a remote memory space which you
3437 want to use for the local device's environment.
3438
3439 - CONFIG_ENV_ADDR:
3440 - CONFIG_ENV_SIZE:
3441
3442 These two #defines specify the address and size of the
3443 environment area within the remote memory space. The
3444 local device can get the environment from remote memory
Liu Gangfc54c7f2012-08-09 05:10:01 +00003445 space by SRIO or PCIE links.
Liu Gang0a85a9e2012-03-08 00:33:20 +00003446
3447BE CAREFUL! For some special cases, the local device can not use
3448"saveenv" command. For example, the local device will get the
Liu Gangfc54c7f2012-08-09 05:10:01 +00003449environment stored in a remote NOR flash by SRIO or PCIE link,
3450but it can not erase, write this NOR flash by SRIO or PCIE interface.
Liu Gang0a85a9e2012-03-08 00:33:20 +00003451
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD51bfee12008-09-10 22:47:58 +02003452- CONFIG_ENV_IS_IN_NAND:
wdenk13a56952004-06-09 14:58:14 +00003453
3454 Define this if you have a NAND device which you want to use
3455 for the environment.
3456
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD0e8d1582008-09-10 22:48:06 +02003457 - CONFIG_ENV_OFFSET:
3458 - CONFIG_ENV_SIZE:
wdenk13a56952004-06-09 14:58:14 +00003459
3460 These two #defines specify the offset and size of the environment
Scott Woodfdd813d2010-09-17 14:38:37 -05003461 area within the first NAND device. CONFIG_ENV_OFFSET must be
3462 aligned to an erase block boundary.
wdenk5779d8d2003-12-06 23:55:10 +00003463
Scott Woodfdd813d2010-09-17 14:38:37 -05003464 - CONFIG_ENV_OFFSET_REDUND (optional):
Markus Klotzbuechere443c942006-03-20 18:02:44 +01003465
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD0e8d1582008-09-10 22:48:06 +02003466 This setting describes a second storage area of CONFIG_ENV_SIZE
Scott Woodfdd813d2010-09-17 14:38:37 -05003467 size used to hold a redundant copy of the environment data, so
3468 that there is a valid backup copy in case there is a power failure
Wolfgang Denkc0f40852011-10-26 10:21:21 +00003469 during a "saveenv" operation. CONFIG_ENV_OFFSET_RENDUND must be
Scott Woodfdd813d2010-09-17 14:38:37 -05003470 aligned to an erase block boundary.
Markus Klotzbuechere443c942006-03-20 18:02:44 +01003471
Scott Woodfdd813d2010-09-17 14:38:37 -05003472 - CONFIG_ENV_RANGE (optional):
3473
3474 Specifies the length of the region in which the environment
3475 can be written. This should be a multiple of the NAND device's
3476 block size. Specifying a range with more erase blocks than
3477 are needed to hold CONFIG_ENV_SIZE allows bad blocks within
3478 the range to be avoided.
3479
3480 - CONFIG_ENV_OFFSET_OOB (optional):
3481
3482 Enables support for dynamically retrieving the offset of the
3483 environment from block zero's out-of-band data. The
3484 "nand env.oob" command can be used to record this offset.
3485 Currently, CONFIG_ENV_OFFSET_REDUND is not supported when
3486 using CONFIG_ENV_OFFSET_OOB.
Markus Klotzbuechere443c942006-03-20 18:02:44 +01003487
Guennadi Liakhovetskib74ab732009-05-18 16:07:22 +02003488- CONFIG_NAND_ENV_DST
3489
3490 Defines address in RAM to which the nand_spl code should copy the
3491 environment. If redundant environment is used, it will be copied to
3492 CONFIG_NAND_ENV_DST + CONFIG_ENV_SIZE.
3493
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003494- CONFIG_SYS_SPI_INIT_OFFSET
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003495
3496 Defines offset to the initial SPI buffer area in DPRAM. The
3497 area is used at an early stage (ROM part) if the environment
3498 is configured to reside in the SPI EEPROM: We need a 520 byte
3499 scratch DPRAM area. It is used between the two initialization
3500 calls (spi_init_f() and spi_init_r()). A value of 0xB00 seems
3501 to be a good choice since it makes it far enough from the
3502 start of the data area as well as from the stack pointer.
3503
Bruce Adlere881cb52007-11-02 13:15:42 -07003504Please note that the environment is read-only until the monitor
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003505has been relocated to RAM and a RAM copy of the environment has been
Wolfgang Denkcdb74972010-07-24 21:55:43 +02003506created; also, when using EEPROM you will have to use getenv_f()
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003507until then to read environment variables.
3508
wdenk85ec0bc2003-03-31 16:34:49 +00003509The environment is protected by a CRC32 checksum. Before the monitor
3510is relocated into RAM, as a result of a bad CRC you will be working
3511with the compiled-in default environment - *silently*!!! [This is
3512necessary, because the first environment variable we need is the
3513"baudrate" setting for the console - if we have a bad CRC, we don't
3514have any device yet where we could complain.]
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003515
3516Note: once the monitor has been relocated, then it will complain if
3517the default environment is used; a new CRC is computed as soon as you
wdenk85ec0bc2003-03-31 16:34:49 +00003518use the "saveenv" command to store a valid environment.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003519
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003520- CONFIG_SYS_FAULT_ECHO_LINK_DOWN:
wdenk42d1f032003-10-15 23:53:47 +00003521 Echo the inverted Ethernet link state to the fault LED.
wdenkfc3e2162003-10-08 22:33:00 +00003522
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003523 Note: If this option is active, then CONFIG_SYS_FAULT_MII_ADDR
wdenkfc3e2162003-10-08 22:33:00 +00003524 also needs to be defined.
3525
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003526- CONFIG_SYS_FAULT_MII_ADDR:
wdenk42d1f032003-10-15 23:53:47 +00003527 MII address of the PHY to check for the Ethernet link state.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003528
Ron Madridf5675aa2009-02-18 14:30:44 -08003529- CONFIG_NS16550_MIN_FUNCTIONS:
3530 Define this if you desire to only have use of the NS16550_init
3531 and NS16550_putc functions for the serial driver located at
3532 drivers/serial/ns16550.c. This option is useful for saving
3533 space for already greatly restricted images, including but not
3534 limited to NAND_SPL configurations.
3535
Simon Glassb2b92f52012-11-30 13:01:18 +00003536- CONFIG_DISPLAY_BOARDINFO
3537 Display information about the board that U-Boot is running on
3538 when U-Boot starts up. The board function checkboard() is called
3539 to do this.
3540
Simon Glasse2e3e2b2012-11-30 13:01:19 +00003541- CONFIG_DISPLAY_BOARDINFO_LATE
3542 Similar to the previous option, but display this information
3543 later, once stdio is running and output goes to the LCD, if
3544 present.
3545
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003546Low Level (hardware related) configuration options:
wdenkdc7c9a12003-03-26 06:55:25 +00003547---------------------------------------------------
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003548
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003549- CONFIG_SYS_CACHELINE_SIZE:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003550 Cache Line Size of the CPU.
3551
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003552- CONFIG_SYS_DEFAULT_IMMR:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003553 Default address of the IMMR after system reset.
wdenk2535d602003-07-17 23:16:40 +00003554
wdenk42d1f032003-10-15 23:53:47 +00003555 Needed on some 8260 systems (MPC8260ADS, PQ2FADS-ZU,
3556 and RPXsuper) to be able to adjust the position of
3557 the IMMR register after a reset.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003558
Timur Tabie46fedf2011-08-04 18:03:41 -05003559- CONFIG_SYS_CCSRBAR_DEFAULT:
3560 Default (power-on reset) physical address of CCSR on Freescale
3561 PowerPC SOCs.
3562
3563- CONFIG_SYS_CCSRBAR:
3564 Virtual address of CCSR. On a 32-bit build, this is typically
3565 the same value as CONFIG_SYS_CCSRBAR_DEFAULT.
3566
3567 CONFIG_SYS_DEFAULT_IMMR must also be set to this value,
3568 for cross-platform code that uses that macro instead.
3569
3570- CONFIG_SYS_CCSRBAR_PHYS:
3571 Physical address of CCSR. CCSR can be relocated to a new
3572 physical address, if desired. In this case, this macro should
Wolfgang Denkc0f40852011-10-26 10:21:21 +00003573 be set to that address. Otherwise, it should be set to the
Timur Tabie46fedf2011-08-04 18:03:41 -05003574 same value as CONFIG_SYS_CCSRBAR_DEFAULT. For example, CCSR
3575 is typically relocated on 36-bit builds. It is recommended
3576 that this macro be defined via the _HIGH and _LOW macros:
3577
3578 #define CONFIG_SYS_CCSRBAR_PHYS ((CONFIG_SYS_CCSRBAR_PHYS_HIGH
3579 * 1ull) << 32 | CONFIG_SYS_CCSRBAR_PHYS_LOW)
3580
3581- CONFIG_SYS_CCSRBAR_PHYS_HIGH:
Wolfgang Denk4cf26092011-10-07 09:58:21 +02003582 Bits 33-36 of CONFIG_SYS_CCSRBAR_PHYS. This value is typically
3583 either 0 (32-bit build) or 0xF (36-bit build). This macro is
Timur Tabie46fedf2011-08-04 18:03:41 -05003584 used in assembly code, so it must not contain typecasts or
3585 integer size suffixes (e.g. "ULL").
3586
3587- CONFIG_SYS_CCSRBAR_PHYS_LOW:
3588 Lower 32-bits of CONFIG_SYS_CCSRBAR_PHYS. This macro is
3589 used in assembly code, so it must not contain typecasts or
3590 integer size suffixes (e.g. "ULL").
3591
3592- CONFIG_SYS_CCSR_DO_NOT_RELOCATE:
3593 If this macro is defined, then CONFIG_SYS_CCSRBAR_PHYS will be
3594 forced to a value that ensures that CCSR is not relocated.
3595
wdenk7f6c2cb2002-11-10 22:06:23 +00003596- Floppy Disk Support:
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003597 CONFIG_SYS_FDC_DRIVE_NUMBER
wdenk7f6c2cb2002-11-10 22:06:23 +00003598
3599 the default drive number (default value 0)
3600
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003601 CONFIG_SYS_ISA_IO_STRIDE
wdenk7f6c2cb2002-11-10 22:06:23 +00003602
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02003603 defines the spacing between FDC chipset registers
wdenk7f6c2cb2002-11-10 22:06:23 +00003604 (default value 1)
3605
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003606 CONFIG_SYS_ISA_IO_OFFSET
wdenk7f6c2cb2002-11-10 22:06:23 +00003607
wdenk43d96162003-03-06 00:02:04 +00003608 defines the offset of register from address. It
3609 depends on which part of the data bus is connected to
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02003610 the FDC chipset. (default value 0)
wdenk7f6c2cb2002-11-10 22:06:23 +00003611
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003612 If CONFIG_SYS_ISA_IO_STRIDE CONFIG_SYS_ISA_IO_OFFSET and
3613 CONFIG_SYS_FDC_DRIVE_NUMBER are undefined, they take their
wdenk43d96162003-03-06 00:02:04 +00003614 default value.
wdenk7f6c2cb2002-11-10 22:06:23 +00003615
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003616 if CONFIG_SYS_FDC_HW_INIT is defined, then the function
wdenk43d96162003-03-06 00:02:04 +00003617 fdc_hw_init() is called at the beginning of the FDC
3618 setup. fdc_hw_init() must be provided by the board
3619 source code. It is used to make hardware dependant
3620 initializations.
wdenk7f6c2cb2002-11-10 22:06:23 +00003621
Macpaul Lin0abddf82011-04-11 20:45:32 +00003622- CONFIG_IDE_AHB:
3623 Most IDE controllers were designed to be connected with PCI
3624 interface. Only few of them were designed for AHB interface.
3625 When software is doing ATA command and data transfer to
3626 IDE devices through IDE-AHB controller, some additional
3627 registers accessing to these kind of IDE-AHB controller
3628 is requierd.
3629
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003630- CONFIG_SYS_IMMR: Physical address of the Internal Memory.
wdenkefe2a4d2004-12-16 21:44:03 +00003631 DO NOT CHANGE unless you know exactly what you're
wdenk25d67122004-12-10 11:40:40 +00003632 doing! (11-4) [MPC8xx/82xx systems only]
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003633
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003634- CONFIG_SYS_INIT_RAM_ADDR:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003635
wdenk7152b1d2003-09-05 23:19:14 +00003636 Start address of memory area that can be used for
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003637 initial data and stack; please note that this must be
3638 writable memory that is working WITHOUT special
3639 initialization, i. e. you CANNOT use normal RAM which
3640 will become available only after programming the
3641 memory controller and running certain initialization
3642 sequences.
3643
3644 U-Boot uses the following memory types:
3645 - MPC8xx and MPC8260: IMMR (internal memory of the CPU)
3646 - MPC824X: data cache
3647 - PPC4xx: data cache
3648
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003649- CONFIG_SYS_GBL_DATA_OFFSET:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003650
3651 Offset of the initial data structure in the memory
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003652 area defined by CONFIG_SYS_INIT_RAM_ADDR. Usually
3653 CONFIG_SYS_GBL_DATA_OFFSET is chosen such that the initial
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003654 data is located at the end of the available space
Wolfgang Denk553f0982010-10-26 13:32:32 +02003655 (sometimes written as (CONFIG_SYS_INIT_RAM_SIZE -
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003656 CONFIG_SYS_INIT_DATA_SIZE), and the initial stack is just
3657 below that area (growing from (CONFIG_SYS_INIT_RAM_ADDR +
3658 CONFIG_SYS_GBL_DATA_OFFSET) downward.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003659
3660 Note:
3661 On the MPC824X (or other systems that use the data
3662 cache for initial memory) the address chosen for
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003663 CONFIG_SYS_INIT_RAM_ADDR is basically arbitrary - it must
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003664 point to an otherwise UNUSED address space between
3665 the top of RAM and the start of the PCI space.
3666
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003667- CONFIG_SYS_SIUMCR: SIU Module Configuration (11-6)
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003668
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003669- CONFIG_SYS_SYPCR: System Protection Control (11-9)
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003670
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003671- CONFIG_SYS_TBSCR: Time Base Status and Control (11-26)
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003672
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003673- CONFIG_SYS_PISCR: Periodic Interrupt Status and Control (11-31)
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003674
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003675- CONFIG_SYS_PLPRCR: PLL, Low-Power, and Reset Control Register (15-30)
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003676
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003677- CONFIG_SYS_SCCR: System Clock and reset Control Register (15-27)
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003678
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003679- CONFIG_SYS_OR_TIMING_SDRAM:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003680 SDRAM timing
3681
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003682- CONFIG_SYS_MAMR_PTA:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003683 periodic timer for refresh
3684
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003685- CONFIG_SYS_DER: Debug Event Register (37-47)
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003686
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003687- FLASH_BASE0_PRELIM, FLASH_BASE1_PRELIM, CONFIG_SYS_REMAP_OR_AM,
3688 CONFIG_SYS_PRELIM_OR_AM, CONFIG_SYS_OR_TIMING_FLASH, CONFIG_SYS_OR0_REMAP,
3689 CONFIG_SYS_OR0_PRELIM, CONFIG_SYS_BR0_PRELIM, CONFIG_SYS_OR1_REMAP, CONFIG_SYS_OR1_PRELIM,
3690 CONFIG_SYS_BR1_PRELIM:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003691 Memory Controller Definitions: BR0/1 and OR0/1 (FLASH)
3692
3693- SDRAM_BASE2_PRELIM, SDRAM_BASE3_PRELIM, SDRAM_MAX_SIZE,
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003694 CONFIG_SYS_OR_TIMING_SDRAM, CONFIG_SYS_OR2_PRELIM, CONFIG_SYS_BR2_PRELIM,
3695 CONFIG_SYS_OR3_PRELIM, CONFIG_SYS_BR3_PRELIM:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003696 Memory Controller Definitions: BR2/3 and OR2/3 (SDRAM)
3697
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003698- CONFIG_SYS_MAMR_PTA, CONFIG_SYS_MPTPR_2BK_4K, CONFIG_SYS_MPTPR_1BK_4K, CONFIG_SYS_MPTPR_2BK_8K,
3699 CONFIG_SYS_MPTPR_1BK_8K, CONFIG_SYS_MAMR_8COL, CONFIG_SYS_MAMR_9COL:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003700 Machine Mode Register and Memory Periodic Timer
3701 Prescaler definitions (SDRAM timing)
3702
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003703- CONFIG_SYS_I2C_UCODE_PATCH, CONFIG_SYS_I2C_DPMEM_OFFSET [0x1FC0]:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003704 enable I2C microcode relocation patch (MPC8xx);
3705 define relocation offset in DPRAM [DSP2]
3706
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003707- CONFIG_SYS_SMC_UCODE_PATCH, CONFIG_SYS_SMC_DPMEM_OFFSET [0x1FC0]:
Heiko Schocherb423d052008-01-11 01:12:07 +01003708 enable SMC microcode relocation patch (MPC8xx);
3709 define relocation offset in DPRAM [SMC1]
3710
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003711- CONFIG_SYS_SPI_UCODE_PATCH, CONFIG_SYS_SPI_DPMEM_OFFSET [0x1FC0]:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003712 enable SPI microcode relocation patch (MPC8xx);
3713 define relocation offset in DPRAM [SCC4]
3714
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003715- CONFIG_SYS_USE_OSCCLK:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003716 Use OSCM clock mode on MBX8xx board. Be careful,
3717 wrong setting might damage your board. Read
3718 doc/README.MBX before setting this variable!
3719
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003720- CONFIG_SYS_CPM_POST_WORD_ADDR: (MPC8xx, MPC8260 only)
wdenk43d96162003-03-06 00:02:04 +00003721 Offset of the bootmode word in DPRAM used by post
3722 (Power On Self Tests). This definition overrides
3723 #define'd default value in commproc.h resp.
3724 cpm_8260.h.
wdenkea909b72002-11-21 23:11:29 +00003725
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003726- CONFIG_SYS_PCI_SLV_MEM_LOCAL, CONFIG_SYS_PCI_SLV_MEM_BUS, CONFIG_SYS_PICMR0_MASK_ATTRIB,
3727 CONFIG_SYS_PCI_MSTR0_LOCAL, CONFIG_SYS_PCIMSK0_MASK, CONFIG_SYS_PCI_MSTR1_LOCAL,
3728 CONFIG_SYS_PCIMSK1_MASK, CONFIG_SYS_PCI_MSTR_MEM_LOCAL, CONFIG_SYS_PCI_MSTR_MEM_BUS,
3729 CONFIG_SYS_CPU_PCI_MEM_START, CONFIG_SYS_PCI_MSTR_MEM_SIZE, CONFIG_SYS_POCMR0_MASK_ATTRIB,
3730 CONFIG_SYS_PCI_MSTR_MEMIO_LOCAL, CONFIG_SYS_PCI_MSTR_MEMIO_BUS, CPU_PCI_MEMIO_START,
3731 CONFIG_SYS_PCI_MSTR_MEMIO_SIZE, CONFIG_SYS_POCMR1_MASK_ATTRIB, CONFIG_SYS_PCI_MSTR_IO_LOCAL,
3732 CONFIG_SYS_PCI_MSTR_IO_BUS, CONFIG_SYS_CPU_PCI_IO_START, CONFIG_SYS_PCI_MSTR_IO_SIZE,
3733 CONFIG_SYS_POCMR2_MASK_ATTRIB: (MPC826x only)
Stefan Roesea47a12b2010-04-15 16:07:28 +02003734 Overrides the default PCI memory map in arch/powerpc/cpu/mpc8260/pci.c if set.
wdenk5d232d02003-05-22 22:52:13 +00003735
Dirk Eibach9cacf4f2009-02-09 08:18:34 +01003736- CONFIG_PCI_DISABLE_PCIE:
3737 Disable PCI-Express on systems where it is supported but not
3738 required.
3739
Andrew Sharp69fd2d32012-08-29 14:16:32 +00003740- CONFIG_PCI_ENUM_ONLY
3741 Only scan through and get the devices on the busses.
3742 Don't do any setup work, presumably because someone or
3743 something has already done it, and we don't need to do it
3744 a second time. Useful for platforms that are pre-booted
3745 by coreboot or similar.
3746
Kumar Galaa09b9b62010-12-30 12:09:53 -06003747- CONFIG_SYS_SRIO:
3748 Chip has SRIO or not
3749
3750- CONFIG_SRIO1:
3751 Board has SRIO 1 port available
3752
3753- CONFIG_SRIO2:
3754 Board has SRIO 2 port available
3755
3756- CONFIG_SYS_SRIOn_MEM_VIRT:
3757 Virtual Address of SRIO port 'n' memory region
3758
3759- CONFIG_SYS_SRIOn_MEM_PHYS:
3760 Physical Address of SRIO port 'n' memory region
3761
3762- CONFIG_SYS_SRIOn_MEM_SIZE:
3763 Size of SRIO port 'n' memory region
3764
Alex Watermaneced4622011-05-19 15:08:36 -04003765- CONFIG_SYS_NDFC_16
3766 Defined to tell the NDFC that the NAND chip is using a
3767 16 bit bus.
3768
3769- CONFIG_SYS_NDFC_EBC0_CFG
3770 Sets the EBC0_CFG register for the NDFC. If not defined
3771 a default value will be used.
3772
Ben Warrenbb99ad62006-09-07 16:50:54 -04003773- CONFIG_SPD_EEPROM
Wolfgang Denk218ca722008-03-26 10:40:12 +01003774 Get DDR timing information from an I2C EEPROM. Common
3775 with pluggable memory modules such as SODIMMs
3776
Ben Warrenbb99ad62006-09-07 16:50:54 -04003777 SPD_EEPROM_ADDRESS
3778 I2C address of the SPD EEPROM
3779
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003780- CONFIG_SYS_SPD_BUS_NUM
Wolfgang Denk218ca722008-03-26 10:40:12 +01003781 If SPD EEPROM is on an I2C bus other than the first
3782 one, specify here. Note that the value must resolve
3783 to something your driver can deal with.
Ben Warrenbb99ad62006-09-07 16:50:54 -04003784
York Sun1b3e3c42011-06-07 09:42:16 +08003785- CONFIG_SYS_DDR_RAW_TIMING
3786 Get DDR timing information from other than SPD. Common with
3787 soldered DDR chips onboard without SPD. DDR raw timing
3788 parameters are extracted from datasheet and hard-coded into
3789 header files or board specific files.
3790
York Sun6f5e1dc2011-09-16 13:21:35 -07003791- CONFIG_FSL_DDR_INTERACTIVE
3792 Enable interactive DDR debugging. See doc/README.fsl-ddr.
3793
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02003794- CONFIG_SYS_83XX_DDR_USES_CS0
Wolfgang Denk218ca722008-03-26 10:40:12 +01003795 Only for 83xx systems. If specified, then DDR should
3796 be configured using CS0 and CS1 instead of CS2 and CS3.
Timur Tabi2ad6b512006-10-31 18:44:42 -06003797
wdenkc26e4542004-04-18 10:13:26 +00003798- CONFIG_ETHER_ON_FEC[12]
3799 Define to enable FEC[12] on a 8xx series processor.
3800
3801- CONFIG_FEC[12]_PHY
3802 Define to the hardcoded PHY address which corresponds
wdenk6e592382004-04-18 17:39:38 +00003803 to the given FEC; i. e.
3804 #define CONFIG_FEC1_PHY 4
wdenkc26e4542004-04-18 10:13:26 +00003805 means that the PHY with address 4 is connected to FEC1
3806
3807 When set to -1, means to probe for first available.
3808
3809- CONFIG_FEC[12]_PHY_NORXERR
3810 The PHY does not have a RXERR line (RMII only).
3811 (so program the FEC to ignore it).
3812
3813- CONFIG_RMII
3814 Enable RMII mode for all FECs.
3815 Note that this is a global option, we can't
3816 have one FEC in standard MII mode and another in RMII mode.
3817
wdenk5cf91d62004-04-23 20:32:05 +00003818- CONFIG_CRC32_VERIFY
3819 Add a verify option to the crc32 command.
3820 The syntax is:
3821
3822 => crc32 -v <address> <count> <crc32>
3823
3824 Where address/count indicate a memory area
3825 and crc32 is the correct crc32 which the
3826 area should have.
3827
wdenk56523f12004-07-11 17:40:54 +00003828- CONFIG_LOOPW
3829 Add the "loopw" memory command. This only takes effect if
Jon Loeliger602ad3b2007-06-11 19:03:39 -05003830 the memory commands are activated globally (CONFIG_CMD_MEM).
wdenk56523f12004-07-11 17:40:54 +00003831
stroese7b466642004-12-16 18:46:55 +00003832- CONFIG_MX_CYCLIC
3833 Add the "mdc" and "mwc" memory commands. These are cyclic
3834 "md/mw" commands.
3835 Examples:
3836
wdenkefe2a4d2004-12-16 21:44:03 +00003837 => mdc.b 10 4 500
stroese7b466642004-12-16 18:46:55 +00003838 This command will print 4 bytes (10,11,12,13) each 500 ms.
3839
wdenkefe2a4d2004-12-16 21:44:03 +00003840 => mwc.l 100 12345678 10
stroese7b466642004-12-16 18:46:55 +00003841 This command will write 12345678 to address 100 all 10 ms.
3842
wdenkefe2a4d2004-12-16 21:44:03 +00003843 This only takes effect if the memory commands are activated
Jon Loeliger602ad3b2007-06-11 19:03:39 -05003844 globally (CONFIG_CMD_MEM).
stroese7b466642004-12-16 18:46:55 +00003845
wdenk8aa1a2d2005-04-04 12:44:11 +00003846- CONFIG_SKIP_LOWLEVEL_INIT
Macpaul Linafc1ce82011-10-19 20:41:11 +00003847 [ARM, NDS32, MIPS only] If this variable is defined, then certain
Wolfgang Denk844f07d2010-11-27 23:30:56 +01003848 low level initializations (like setting up the memory
3849 controller) are omitted and/or U-Boot does not
3850 relocate itself into RAM.
wdenk8aa1a2d2005-04-04 12:44:11 +00003851
Wolfgang Denk844f07d2010-11-27 23:30:56 +01003852 Normally this variable MUST NOT be defined. The only
3853 exception is when U-Boot is loaded (to RAM) by some
3854 other boot loader or by a debugger which performs
3855 these initializations itself.
wdenk8aa1a2d2005-04-04 12:44:11 +00003856
Aneesh V401bb302011-07-13 05:11:07 +00003857- CONFIG_SPL_BUILD
Magnus Liljadf812382009-06-13 20:50:00 +02003858 Modifies the behaviour of start.S when compiling a loader
3859 that is executed before the actual U-Boot. E.g. when
3860 compiling a NAND SPL.
wdenk400558b2005-04-02 23:52:25 +00003861
Simon Glass4213fc22013-02-24 17:33:14 +00003862- CONFIG_ARCH_MAP_SYSMEM
3863 Generally U-Boot (and in particular the md command) uses
3864 effective address. It is therefore not necessary to regard
3865 U-Boot address as virtual addresses that need to be translated
3866 to physical addresses. However, sandbox requires this, since
3867 it maintains its own little RAM buffer which contains all
3868 addressable memory. This option causes some memory accesses
3869 to be mapped through map_sysmem() / unmap_sysmem().
3870
Matthias Weisserd8834a12011-03-10 21:36:32 +00003871- CONFIG_USE_ARCH_MEMCPY
3872 CONFIG_USE_ARCH_MEMSET
3873 If these options are used a optimized version of memcpy/memset will
3874 be used if available. These functions may be faster under some
3875 conditions but may increase the binary size.
3876
Simon Glass588a13f2013-02-14 04:18:54 +00003877- CONFIG_X86_RESET_VECTOR
3878 If defined, the x86 reset vector code is included. This is not
3879 needed when U-Boot is running from Coreboot.
Gabe Blackb16f5212012-11-27 21:08:06 +00003880
Mark Jacksonfc337052013-03-04 01:27:20 +00003881- CONFIG_SYS_MPUCLK
3882 Defines the MPU clock speed (in MHz).
3883
3884 NOTE : currently only supported on AM335x platforms.
Gabe Black5b5ece92012-11-29 16:23:41 +00003885
Timur Tabif2717b42011-11-22 09:21:25 -06003886Freescale QE/FMAN Firmware Support:
3887-----------------------------------
3888
3889The Freescale QUICCEngine (QE) and Frame Manager (FMAN) both support the
3890loading of "firmware", which is encoded in the QE firmware binary format.
3891This firmware often needs to be loaded during U-Boot booting, so macros
3892are used to identify the storage device (NOR flash, SPI, etc) and the address
3893within that device.
3894
3895- CONFIG_SYS_QE_FMAN_FW_ADDR
3896 The address in the storage device where the firmware is located. The
3897 meaning of this address depends on which CONFIG_SYS_QE_FW_IN_xxx macro
3898 is also specified.
3899
3900- CONFIG_SYS_QE_FMAN_FW_LENGTH
3901 The maximum possible size of the firmware. The firmware binary format
3902 has a field that specifies the actual size of the firmware, but it
3903 might not be possible to read any part of the firmware unless some
3904 local storage is allocated to hold the entire firmware first.
3905
3906- CONFIG_SYS_QE_FMAN_FW_IN_NOR
3907 Specifies that QE/FMAN firmware is located in NOR flash, mapped as
3908 normal addressable memory via the LBC. CONFIG_SYS_FMAN_FW_ADDR is the
3909 virtual address in NOR flash.
3910
3911- CONFIG_SYS_QE_FMAN_FW_IN_NAND
3912 Specifies that QE/FMAN firmware is located in NAND flash.
3913 CONFIG_SYS_FMAN_FW_ADDR is the offset within NAND flash.
3914
3915- CONFIG_SYS_QE_FMAN_FW_IN_MMC
3916 Specifies that QE/FMAN firmware is located on the primary SD/MMC
3917 device. CONFIG_SYS_FMAN_FW_ADDR is the byte offset on that device.
3918
3919- CONFIG_SYS_QE_FMAN_FW_IN_SPIFLASH
3920 Specifies that QE/FMAN firmware is located on the primary SPI
3921 device. CONFIG_SYS_FMAN_FW_ADDR is the byte offset on that device.
3922
Liu Gang292dc6c2012-03-08 00:33:18 +00003923- CONFIG_SYS_QE_FMAN_FW_IN_REMOTE
3924 Specifies that QE/FMAN firmware is located in the remote (master)
3925 memory space. CONFIG_SYS_FMAN_FW_ADDR is a virtual address which
Liu Gangfc54c7f2012-08-09 05:10:01 +00003926 can be mapped from slave TLB->slave LAW->slave SRIO or PCIE outbound
3927 window->master inbound window->master LAW->the ucode address in
3928 master's memory space.
Timur Tabif2717b42011-11-22 09:21:25 -06003929
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003930Building the Software:
3931======================
3932
Wolfgang Denk218ca722008-03-26 10:40:12 +01003933Building U-Boot has been tested in several native build environments
3934and in many different cross environments. Of course we cannot support
3935all possibly existing versions of cross development tools in all
3936(potentially obsolete) versions. In case of tool chain problems we
3937recommend to use the ELDK (see http://www.denx.de/wiki/DULG/ELDK)
3938which is extensively used to build and test U-Boot.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003939
Wolfgang Denk218ca722008-03-26 10:40:12 +01003940If you are not using a native environment, it is assumed that you
3941have GNU cross compiling tools available in your path. In this case,
3942you must set the environment variable CROSS_COMPILE in your shell.
3943Note that no changes to the Makefile or any other source files are
3944necessary. For example using the ELDK on a 4xx CPU, please enter:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003945
Wolfgang Denk218ca722008-03-26 10:40:12 +01003946 $ CROSS_COMPILE=ppc_4xx-
3947 $ export CROSS_COMPILE
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003948
Peter Tyser2f8d3962009-03-13 18:54:51 -05003949Note: If you wish to generate Windows versions of the utilities in
3950 the tools directory you can use the MinGW toolchain
3951 (http://www.mingw.org). Set your HOST tools to the MinGW
3952 toolchain and execute 'make tools'. For example:
3953
3954 $ make HOSTCC=i586-mingw32msvc-gcc HOSTSTRIP=i586-mingw32msvc-strip tools
3955
3956 Binaries such as tools/mkimage.exe will be created which can
3957 be executed on computers running Windows.
3958
Wolfgang Denk218ca722008-03-26 10:40:12 +01003959U-Boot is intended to be simple to build. After installing the
3960sources you must configure U-Boot for one specific board type. This
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003961is done by typing:
3962
3963 make NAME_config
3964
Wolfgang Denk218ca722008-03-26 10:40:12 +01003965where "NAME_config" is the name of one of the existing configu-
Michael Jones4d675ae2012-03-15 22:48:10 +00003966rations; see boards.cfg for supported names.
wdenk54387ac2003-10-08 22:45:44 +00003967
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00003968Note: for some board special configuration names may exist; check if
3969 additional information is available from the board vendor; for
3970 instance, the TQM823L systems are available without (standard)
3971 or with LCD support. You can select such additional "features"
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02003972 when choosing the configuration, i. e.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003973
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00003974 make TQM823L_config
3975 - will configure for a plain TQM823L, i. e. no LCD support
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003976
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00003977 make TQM823L_LCD_config
3978 - will configure for a TQM823L with U-Boot console on LCD
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003979
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00003980 etc.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003981
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003982
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00003983Finally, type "make all", and you should get some working U-Boot
3984images ready for download to / installation on your system:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003985
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00003986- "u-boot.bin" is a raw binary image
3987- "u-boot" is an image in ELF binary format
3988- "u-boot.srec" is in Motorola S-Record format
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00003989
Marian Balakowiczbaf31242006-09-07 17:25:40 +02003990By default the build is performed locally and the objects are saved
3991in the source directory. One of the two methods can be used to change
3992this behavior and build U-Boot to some external directory:
3993
39941. Add O= to the make command line invocations:
3995
3996 make O=/tmp/build distclean
3997 make O=/tmp/build NAME_config
3998 make O=/tmp/build all
3999
40002. Set environment variable BUILD_DIR to point to the desired location:
4001
4002 export BUILD_DIR=/tmp/build
4003 make distclean
4004 make NAME_config
4005 make all
4006
4007Note that the command line "O=" setting overrides the BUILD_DIR environment
4008variable.
4009
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004010
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004011Please be aware that the Makefiles assume you are using GNU make, so
4012for instance on NetBSD you might need to use "gmake" instead of
4013native "make".
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004014
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004015
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004016If the system board that you have is not listed, then you will need
4017to port U-Boot to your hardware platform. To do this, follow these
4018steps:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004019
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +000040201. Add a new configuration option for your board to the toplevel
Michael Jones4d675ae2012-03-15 22:48:10 +00004021 "boards.cfg" file, using the existing entries as examples.
4022 Follow the instructions there to keep the boards in order.
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +000040232. Create a new directory to hold your board specific code. Add any
4024 files you need. In your board directory, you will need at least
4025 the "Makefile", a "<board>.c", "flash.c" and "u-boot.lds".
40263. Create a new configuration file "include/configs/<board>.h" for
4027 your board
40283. If you're porting U-Boot to a new CPU, then also create a new
4029 directory to hold your CPU specific code. Add any files you need.
40304. Run "make <board>_config" with your new name.
40315. Type "make", and you should get a working "u-boot.srec" file
4032 to be installed on your target system.
40336. Debug and solve any problems that might arise.
4034 [Of course, this last step is much harder than it sounds.]
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004035
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004036
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004037Testing of U-Boot Modifications, Ports to New Hardware, etc.:
4038==============================================================
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004039
Wolfgang Denk218ca722008-03-26 10:40:12 +01004040If you have modified U-Boot sources (for instance added a new board
4041or support for new devices, a new CPU, etc.) you are expected to
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004042provide feedback to the other developers. The feedback normally takes
4043the form of a "patch", i. e. a context diff against a certain (latest
Wolfgang Denk218ca722008-03-26 10:40:12 +01004044official or latest in the git repository) version of U-Boot sources.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004045
Wolfgang Denk218ca722008-03-26 10:40:12 +01004046But before you submit such a patch, please verify that your modifi-
4047cation did not break existing code. At least make sure that *ALL* of
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004048the supported boards compile WITHOUT ANY compiler warnings. To do so,
4049just run the "MAKEALL" script, which will configure and build U-Boot
Wolfgang Denk218ca722008-03-26 10:40:12 +01004050for ALL supported system. Be warned, this will take a while. You can
4051select which (cross) compiler to use by passing a `CROSS_COMPILE'
4052environment variable to the script, i. e. to use the ELDK cross tools
4053you can type
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004054
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004055 CROSS_COMPILE=ppc_8xx- MAKEALL
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004056
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004057or to build on a native PowerPC system you can type
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004058
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004059 CROSS_COMPILE=' ' MAKEALL
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004060
Wolfgang Denk218ca722008-03-26 10:40:12 +01004061When using the MAKEALL script, the default behaviour is to build
4062U-Boot in the source directory. This location can be changed by
4063setting the BUILD_DIR environment variable. Also, for each target
4064built, the MAKEALL script saves two log files (<target>.ERR and
4065<target>.MAKEALL) in the <source dir>/LOG directory. This default
4066location can be changed by setting the MAKEALL_LOGDIR environment
4067variable. For example:
Marian Balakowiczbaf31242006-09-07 17:25:40 +02004068
4069 export BUILD_DIR=/tmp/build
4070 export MAKEALL_LOGDIR=/tmp/log
4071 CROSS_COMPILE=ppc_8xx- MAKEALL
4072
Wolfgang Denk218ca722008-03-26 10:40:12 +01004073With the above settings build objects are saved in the /tmp/build,
4074log files are saved in the /tmp/log and the source tree remains clean
4075during the whole build process.
Marian Balakowiczbaf31242006-09-07 17:25:40 +02004076
4077
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004078See also "U-Boot Porting Guide" below.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004079
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004080
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004081Monitor Commands - Overview:
4082============================
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004083
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004084go - start application at address 'addr'
4085run - run commands in an environment variable
4086bootm - boot application image from memory
4087bootp - boot image via network using BootP/TFTP protocol
Marek Vasut44f074c2012-03-14 21:52:45 +00004088bootz - boot zImage from memory
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004089tftpboot- boot image via network using TFTP protocol
4090 and env variables "ipaddr" and "serverip"
4091 (and eventually "gatewayip")
Simon Glass1fb7cd42011-10-24 18:00:07 +00004092tftpput - upload a file via network using TFTP protocol
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004093rarpboot- boot image via network using RARP/TFTP protocol
4094diskboot- boot from IDE devicebootd - boot default, i.e., run 'bootcmd'
4095loads - load S-Record file over serial line
4096loadb - load binary file over serial line (kermit mode)
4097md - memory display
4098mm - memory modify (auto-incrementing)
4099nm - memory modify (constant address)
4100mw - memory write (fill)
4101cp - memory copy
4102cmp - memory compare
4103crc32 - checksum calculation
Peter Tyser0f89c542009-04-18 22:34:03 -05004104i2c - I2C sub-system
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004105sspi - SPI utility commands
4106base - print or set address offset
4107printenv- print environment variables
4108setenv - set environment variables
4109saveenv - save environment variables to persistent storage
4110protect - enable or disable FLASH write protection
4111erase - erase FLASH memory
4112flinfo - print FLASH memory information
Karl O. Pinc10635af2012-08-03 05:57:21 +00004113nand - NAND memory operations (see doc/README.nand)
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004114bdinfo - print Board Info structure
4115iminfo - print header information for application image
4116coninfo - print console devices and informations
4117ide - IDE sub-system
4118loop - infinite loop on address range
wdenk56523f12004-07-11 17:40:54 +00004119loopw - infinite write loop on address range
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004120mtest - simple RAM test
4121icache - enable or disable instruction cache
4122dcache - enable or disable data cache
4123reset - Perform RESET of the CPU
4124echo - echo args to console
4125version - print monitor version
4126help - print online help
4127? - alias for 'help'
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004128
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004129
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004130Monitor Commands - Detailed Description:
4131========================================
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004132
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004133TODO.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004134
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004135For now: just type "help <command>".
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004136
4137
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004138Environment Variables:
4139======================
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004140
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004141U-Boot supports user configuration using Environment Variables which
4142can be made persistent by saving to Flash memory.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004143
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004144Environment Variables are set using "setenv", printed using
4145"printenv", and saved to Flash using "saveenv". Using "setenv"
4146without a value can be used to delete a variable from the
4147environment. As long as you don't save the environment you are
4148working with an in-memory copy. In case the Flash area containing the
4149environment is erased by accident, a default environment is provided.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004150
Wolfgang Denkc96f86e2010-01-17 23:55:53 +01004151Some configuration options can be set using Environment Variables.
4152
4153List of environment variables (most likely not complete):
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004154
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004155 baudrate - see CONFIG_BAUDRATE
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004156
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004157 bootdelay - see CONFIG_BOOTDELAY
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004158
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004159 bootcmd - see CONFIG_BOOTCOMMAND
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004160
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004161 bootargs - Boot arguments when booting an RTOS image
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004162
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004163 bootfile - Name of the image to load with TFTP
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004164
Bartlomiej Sieka7d721e32008-04-14 15:44:16 +02004165 bootm_low - Memory range available for image processing in the bootm
4166 command can be restricted. This variable is given as
4167 a hexadecimal number and defines lowest address allowed
4168 for use by the bootm command. See also "bootm_size"
4169 environment variable. Address defined by "bootm_low" is
4170 also the base of the initial memory mapping for the Linux
Grant Likelyc3624e62011-03-28 09:58:43 +00004171 kernel -- see the description of CONFIG_SYS_BOOTMAPSZ and
4172 bootm_mapsize.
4173
Wolfgang Denkc0f40852011-10-26 10:21:21 +00004174 bootm_mapsize - Size of the initial memory mapping for the Linux kernel.
Grant Likelyc3624e62011-03-28 09:58:43 +00004175 This variable is given as a hexadecimal number and it
4176 defines the size of the memory region starting at base
4177 address bootm_low that is accessible by the Linux kernel
4178 during early boot. If unset, CONFIG_SYS_BOOTMAPSZ is used
4179 as the default value if it is defined, and bootm_size is
4180 used otherwise.
Bartlomiej Sieka7d721e32008-04-14 15:44:16 +02004181
4182 bootm_size - Memory range available for image processing in the bootm
4183 command can be restricted. This variable is given as
4184 a hexadecimal number and defines the size of the region
4185 allowed for use by the bootm command. See also "bootm_low"
4186 environment variable.
4187
Bartlomiej Sieka4bae9092008-10-01 15:26:31 +02004188 updatefile - Location of the software update file on a TFTP server, used
4189 by the automatic software update feature. Please refer to
4190 documentation in doc/README.update for more details.
4191
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004192 autoload - if set to "no" (any string beginning with 'n'),
4193 "bootp" will just load perform a lookup of the
4194 configuration from the BOOTP server, but not try to
4195 load any image using TFTP
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004196
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004197 autostart - if set to "yes", an image loaded using the "bootp",
4198 "rarpboot", "tftpboot" or "diskboot" commands will
4199 be automatically started (by internally calling
4200 "bootm")
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004201
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004202 If set to "no", a standalone image passed to the
4203 "bootm" command will be copied to the load address
4204 (and eventually uncompressed), but NOT be started.
4205 This can be used to load and uncompress arbitrary
4206 data.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004207
David A. Longa28afca2011-07-09 16:40:19 -04004208 fdt_high - if set this restricts the maximum address that the
4209 flattened device tree will be copied into upon boot.
Shawn Guofa34f6b2012-01-09 21:54:08 +00004210 For example, if you have a system with 1 GB memory
4211 at physical address 0x10000000, while Linux kernel
4212 only recognizes the first 704 MB as low memory, you
4213 may need to set fdt_high as 0x3C000000 to have the
4214 device tree blob be copied to the maximum address
4215 of the 704 MB low memory, so that Linux kernel can
4216 access it during the boot procedure.
4217
David A. Longa28afca2011-07-09 16:40:19 -04004218 If this is set to the special value 0xFFFFFFFF then
4219 the fdt will not be copied at all on boot. For this
4220 to work it must reside in writable memory, have
4221 sufficient padding on the end of it for u-boot to
4222 add the information it needs into it, and the memory
4223 must be accessible by the kernel.
4224
Simon Glasseea63e02011-10-24 19:15:34 +00004225 fdtcontroladdr- if set this is the address of the control flattened
4226 device tree used by U-Boot when CONFIG_OF_CONTROL is
4227 defined.
4228
wdenk17ea1172004-06-06 21:51:03 +00004229 i2cfast - (PPC405GP|PPC405EP only)
4230 if set to 'y' configures Linux I2C driver for fast
4231 mode (400kHZ). This environment variable is used in
4232 initialization code. So, for changes to be effective
4233 it must be saved and board must be reset.
4234
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004235 initrd_high - restrict positioning of initrd images:
4236 If this variable is not set, initrd images will be
4237 copied to the highest possible address in RAM; this
4238 is usually what you want since it allows for
4239 maximum initrd size. If for some reason you want to
4240 make sure that the initrd image is loaded below the
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02004241 CONFIG_SYS_BOOTMAPSZ limit, you can set this environment
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004242 variable to a value of "no" or "off" or "0".
4243 Alternatively, you can set it to a maximum upper
4244 address to use (U-Boot will still check that it
4245 does not overwrite the U-Boot stack and data).
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004246
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004247 For instance, when you have a system with 16 MB
4248 RAM, and want to reserve 4 MB from use by Linux,
4249 you can do this by adding "mem=12M" to the value of
4250 the "bootargs" variable. However, now you must make
4251 sure that the initrd image is placed in the first
4252 12 MB as well - this can be done with
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004253
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004254 setenv initrd_high 00c00000
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004255
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004256 If you set initrd_high to 0xFFFFFFFF, this is an
4257 indication to U-Boot that all addresses are legal
4258 for the Linux kernel, including addresses in flash
4259 memory. In this case U-Boot will NOT COPY the
4260 ramdisk at all. This may be useful to reduce the
4261 boot time on your system, but requires that this
4262 feature is supported by your Linux kernel.
wdenk4a6fd342003-04-12 23:38:12 +00004263
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004264 ipaddr - IP address; needed for tftpboot command
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004265
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004266 loadaddr - Default load address for commands like "bootp",
4267 "rarpboot", "tftpboot", "loadb" or "diskboot"
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004268
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004269 loads_echo - see CONFIG_LOADS_ECHO
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004270
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004271 serverip - TFTP server IP address; needed for tftpboot command
wdenk38b99262003-05-23 23:18:21 +00004272
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004273 bootretry - see CONFIG_BOOT_RETRY_TIME
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004274
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004275 bootdelaykey - see CONFIG_AUTOBOOT_DELAY_STR
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004276
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004277 bootstopkey - see CONFIG_AUTOBOOT_STOP_STR
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004278
Mike Frysingere2a53452011-10-02 10:01:27 +00004279 ethprime - controls which interface is used first.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004280
Mike Frysingere2a53452011-10-02 10:01:27 +00004281 ethact - controls which interface is currently active.
4282 For example you can do the following
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004283
Heiko Schocher48690d82010-07-20 17:45:02 +02004284 => setenv ethact FEC
4285 => ping 192.168.0.1 # traffic sent on FEC
4286 => setenv ethact SCC
4287 => ping 10.0.0.1 # traffic sent on SCC
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004288
Matthias Fuchse1692572008-01-17 07:45:05 +01004289 ethrotate - When set to "no" U-Boot does not go through all
4290 available network interfaces.
4291 It just stays at the currently selected interface.
4292
Wolfgang Denkc96f86e2010-01-17 23:55:53 +01004293 netretry - When set to "no" each network operation will
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004294 either succeed or fail without retrying.
4295 When set to "once" the network operation will
4296 fail when all the available network interfaces
4297 are tried once without success.
4298 Useful on scripts which control the retry operation
4299 themselves.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004300
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARDb4e2f892009-01-31 09:53:39 +01004301 npe_ucode - set load address for the NPE microcode
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARDa1cf0272008-01-07 08:41:34 +01004302
Wolfgang Denk28cb9372005-09-24 23:25:46 +02004303 tftpsrcport - If this is set, the value is used for TFTP's
Wolfgang Denkecb0ccd2005-09-24 22:37:32 +02004304 UDP source port.
4305
Wolfgang Denk28cb9372005-09-24 23:25:46 +02004306 tftpdstport - If this is set, the value is used for TFTP's UDP
4307 destination port instead of the Well Know Port 69.
4308
Wolfgang Denkc96f86e2010-01-17 23:55:53 +01004309 tftpblocksize - Block size to use for TFTP transfers; if not set,
4310 we use the TFTP server's default block size
4311
4312 tftptimeout - Retransmission timeout for TFTP packets (in milli-
4313 seconds, minimum value is 1000 = 1 second). Defines
4314 when a packet is considered to be lost so it has to
4315 be retransmitted. The default is 5000 = 5 seconds.
4316 Lowering this value may make downloads succeed
4317 faster in networks with high packet loss rates or
4318 with unreliable TFTP servers.
4319
4320 vlan - When set to a value < 4095 the traffic over
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02004321 Ethernet is encapsulated/received over 802.1q
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004322 VLAN tagged frames.
wdenka3d991b2004-04-15 21:48:45 +00004323
Jason Hobbsdc0b7b02011-08-31 05:37:28 +00004324The following image location variables contain the location of images
4325used in booting. The "Image" column gives the role of the image and is
4326not an environment variable name. The other columns are environment
4327variable names. "File Name" gives the name of the file on a TFTP
4328server, "RAM Address" gives the location in RAM the image will be
4329loaded to, and "Flash Location" gives the image's address in NOR
4330flash or offset in NAND flash.
4331
4332*Note* - these variables don't have to be defined for all boards, some
4333boards currenlty use other variables for these purposes, and some
4334boards use these variables for other purposes.
4335
Wolfgang Denkc0f40852011-10-26 10:21:21 +00004336Image File Name RAM Address Flash Location
4337----- --------- ----------- --------------
4338u-boot u-boot u-boot_addr_r u-boot_addr
4339Linux kernel bootfile kernel_addr_r kernel_addr
4340device tree blob fdtfile fdt_addr_r fdt_addr
4341ramdisk ramdiskfile ramdisk_addr_r ramdisk_addr
Jason Hobbsdc0b7b02011-08-31 05:37:28 +00004342
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004343The following environment variables may be used and automatically
4344updated by the network boot commands ("bootp" and "rarpboot"),
4345depending the information provided by your boot server:
wdenka3d991b2004-04-15 21:48:45 +00004346
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004347 bootfile - see above
4348 dnsip - IP address of your Domain Name Server
4349 dnsip2 - IP address of your secondary Domain Name Server
4350 gatewayip - IP address of the Gateway (Router) to use
4351 hostname - Target hostname
4352 ipaddr - see above
4353 netmask - Subnet Mask
4354 rootpath - Pathname of the root filesystem on the NFS server
4355 serverip - see above
wdenka3d991b2004-04-15 21:48:45 +00004356
wdenka3d991b2004-04-15 21:48:45 +00004357
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004358There are two special Environment Variables:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004359
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004360 serial# - contains hardware identification information such
4361 as type string and/or serial number
4362 ethaddr - Ethernet address
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004363
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004364These variables can be set only once (usually during manufacturing of
4365the board). U-Boot refuses to delete or overwrite these variables
4366once they have been set once.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004367
4368
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004369Further special Environment Variables:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004370
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004371 ver - Contains the U-Boot version string as printed
4372 with the "version" command. This variable is
4373 readonly (see CONFIG_VERSION_VARIABLE).
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004374
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004375
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004376Please note that changes to some configuration parameters may take
4377only effect after the next boot (yes, that's just like Windoze :-).
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004378
stroesec1551ea2003-04-04 15:53:41 +00004379
Joe Hershberger170ab112012-12-11 22:16:24 -06004380Callback functions for environment variables:
4381---------------------------------------------
4382
4383For some environment variables, the behavior of u-boot needs to change
4384when their values are changed. This functionailty allows functions to
4385be associated with arbitrary variables. On creation, overwrite, or
4386deletion, the callback will provide the opportunity for some side
4387effect to happen or for the change to be rejected.
4388
4389The callbacks are named and associated with a function using the
4390U_BOOT_ENV_CALLBACK macro in your board or driver code.
4391
4392These callbacks are associated with variables in one of two ways. The
4393static list can be added to by defining CONFIG_ENV_CALLBACK_LIST_STATIC
4394in the board configuration to a string that defines a list of
4395associations. The list must be in the following format:
4396
4397 entry = variable_name[:callback_name]
4398 list = entry[,list]
4399
4400If the callback name is not specified, then the callback is deleted.
4401Spaces are also allowed anywhere in the list.
4402
4403Callbacks can also be associated by defining the ".callbacks" variable
4404with the same list format above. Any association in ".callbacks" will
4405override any association in the static list. You can define
4406CONFIG_ENV_CALLBACK_LIST_DEFAULT to a list (string) to define the
4407".callbacks" envirnoment variable in the default or embedded environment.
4408
4409
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004410Command Line Parsing:
4411=====================
stroesec1551ea2003-04-04 15:53:41 +00004412
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004413There are two different command line parsers available with U-Boot:
4414the old "simple" one, and the much more powerful "hush" shell:
stroesec1551ea2003-04-04 15:53:41 +00004415
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004416Old, simple command line parser:
4417--------------------------------
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004418
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004419- supports environment variables (through setenv / saveenv commands)
4420- several commands on one line, separated by ';'
Wolfgang Denkfe126d82005-11-20 21:40:11 +01004421- variable substitution using "... ${name} ..." syntax
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004422- special characters ('$', ';') can be escaped by prefixing with '\',
4423 for example:
Wolfgang Denkfe126d82005-11-20 21:40:11 +01004424 setenv bootcmd bootm \${address}
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004425- You can also escape text by enclosing in single apostrophes, for example:
4426 setenv addip 'setenv bootargs $bootargs ip=$ipaddr:$serverip:$gatewayip:$netmask:$hostname::off'
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004427
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004428Hush shell:
4429-----------
wdenkf07771c2003-05-28 08:06:31 +00004430
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004431- similar to Bourne shell, with control structures like
4432 if...then...else...fi, for...do...done; while...do...done,
4433 until...do...done, ...
4434- supports environment ("global") variables (through setenv / saveenv
4435 commands) and local shell variables (through standard shell syntax
4436 "name=value"); only environment variables can be used with "run"
4437 command
wdenkf07771c2003-05-28 08:06:31 +00004438
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004439General rules:
4440--------------
wdenkf07771c2003-05-28 08:06:31 +00004441
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004442(1) If a command line (or an environment variable executed by a "run"
4443 command) contains several commands separated by semicolon, and
4444 one of these commands fails, then the remaining commands will be
4445 executed anyway.
wdenkf07771c2003-05-28 08:06:31 +00004446
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004447(2) If you execute several variables with one call to run (i. e.
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02004448 calling run with a list of variables as arguments), any failing
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004449 command will cause "run" to terminate, i. e. the remaining
4450 variables are not executed.
wdenkf07771c2003-05-28 08:06:31 +00004451
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004452Note for Redundant Ethernet Interfaces:
4453=======================================
wdenkf07771c2003-05-28 08:06:31 +00004454
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02004455Some boards come with redundant Ethernet interfaces; U-Boot supports
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004456such configurations and is capable of automatic selection of a
4457"working" interface when needed. MAC assignment works as follows:
wdenkf07771c2003-05-28 08:06:31 +00004458
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004459Network interfaces are numbered eth0, eth1, eth2, ... Corresponding
4460MAC addresses can be stored in the environment as "ethaddr" (=>eth0),
4461"eth1addr" (=>eth1), "eth2addr", ...
wdenkf07771c2003-05-28 08:06:31 +00004462
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004463If the network interface stores some valid MAC address (for instance
4464in SROM), this is used as default address if there is NO correspon-
4465ding setting in the environment; if the corresponding environment
4466variable is set, this overrides the settings in the card; that means:
wdenkf07771c2003-05-28 08:06:31 +00004467
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004468o If the SROM has a valid MAC address, and there is no address in the
4469 environment, the SROM's address is used.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004470
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004471o If there is no valid address in the SROM, and a definition in the
4472 environment exists, then the value from the environment variable is
4473 used.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004474
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004475o If both the SROM and the environment contain a MAC address, and
4476 both addresses are the same, this MAC address is used.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004477
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004478o If both the SROM and the environment contain a MAC address, and the
4479 addresses differ, the value from the environment is used and a
4480 warning is printed.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004481
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004482o If neither SROM nor the environment contain a MAC address, an error
4483 is raised.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004484
Ben Warrenecee9322010-04-26 11:11:46 -07004485If Ethernet drivers implement the 'write_hwaddr' function, valid MAC addresses
Wolfgang Denkc0f40852011-10-26 10:21:21 +00004486will be programmed into hardware as part of the initialization process. This
Ben Warrenecee9322010-04-26 11:11:46 -07004487may be skipped by setting the appropriate 'ethmacskip' environment variable.
4488The naming convention is as follows:
4489"ethmacskip" (=>eth0), "eth1macskip" (=>eth1) etc.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004490
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004491Image Formats:
4492==============
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004493
Marian Balakowicz3310c542008-03-12 12:13:13 +01004494U-Boot is capable of booting (and performing other auxiliary operations on)
4495images in two formats:
4496
4497New uImage format (FIT)
4498-----------------------
4499
4500Flexible and powerful format based on Flattened Image Tree -- FIT (similar
4501to Flattened Device Tree). It allows the use of images with multiple
4502components (several kernels, ramdisks, etc.), with contents protected by
4503SHA1, MD5 or CRC32. More details are found in the doc/uImage.FIT directory.
4504
4505
4506Old uImage format
4507-----------------
4508
4509Old image format is based on binary files which can be basically anything,
4510preceded by a special header; see the definitions in include/image.h for
4511details; basically, the header defines the following image properties:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004512
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004513* Target Operating System (Provisions for OpenBSD, NetBSD, FreeBSD,
4514 4.4BSD, Linux, SVR4, Esix, Solaris, Irix, SCO, Dell, NCR, VxWorks,
Peter Tyserf5ed9e32008-09-08 14:56:49 -05004515 LynxOS, pSOS, QNX, RTEMS, INTEGRITY;
4516 Currently supported: Linux, NetBSD, VxWorks, QNX, RTEMS, LynxOS,
4517 INTEGRITY).
Wolfgang Denk7b64fef2006-10-24 14:21:16 +02004518* Target CPU Architecture (Provisions for Alpha, ARM, AVR32, Intel x86,
Macpaul Linafc1ce82011-10-19 20:41:11 +00004519 IA64, MIPS, NDS32, Nios II, PowerPC, IBM S390, SuperH, Sparc, Sparc 64 Bit;
4520 Currently supported: ARM, AVR32, Intel x86, MIPS, NDS32, Nios II, PowerPC).
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004521* Compression Type (uncompressed, gzip, bzip2)
4522* Load Address
4523* Entry Point
4524* Image Name
4525* Image Timestamp
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004526
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004527The header is marked by a special Magic Number, and both the header
4528and the data portions of the image are secured against corruption by
4529CRC32 checksums.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004530
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004531
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004532Linux Support:
4533==============
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004534
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004535Although U-Boot should support any OS or standalone application
4536easily, the main focus has always been on Linux during the design of
4537U-Boot.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004538
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004539U-Boot includes many features that so far have been part of some
4540special "boot loader" code within the Linux kernel. Also, any
4541"initrd" images to be used are no longer part of one big Linux image;
4542instead, kernel and "initrd" are separate images. This implementation
4543serves several purposes:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004544
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004545- the same features can be used for other OS or standalone
4546 applications (for instance: using compressed images to reduce the
4547 Flash memory footprint)
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004548
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004549- it becomes much easier to port new Linux kernel versions because
4550 lots of low-level, hardware dependent stuff are done by U-Boot
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004551
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004552- the same Linux kernel image can now be used with different "initrd"
4553 images; of course this also means that different kernel images can
4554 be run with the same "initrd". This makes testing easier (you don't
4555 have to build a new "zImage.initrd" Linux image when you just
4556 change a file in your "initrd"). Also, a field-upgrade of the
4557 software is easier now.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004558
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004559
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004560Linux HOWTO:
4561============
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004562
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004563Porting Linux to U-Boot based systems:
4564---------------------------------------
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004565
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004566U-Boot cannot save you from doing all the necessary modifications to
4567configure the Linux device drivers for use with your target hardware
4568(no, we don't intend to provide a full virtual machine interface to
4569Linux :-).
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004570
Stefan Roesea47a12b2010-04-15 16:07:28 +02004571But now you can ignore ALL boot loader code (in arch/powerpc/mbxboot).
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004572
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004573Just make sure your machine specific header file (for instance
4574include/asm-ppc/tqm8xx.h) includes the same definition of the Board
Markus Heidelberg1dc30692008-09-07 20:18:27 +02004575Information structure as we define in include/asm-<arch>/u-boot.h,
4576and make sure that your definition of IMAP_ADDR uses the same value
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02004577as your U-Boot configuration in CONFIG_SYS_IMMR.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004578
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004579
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004580Configuring the Linux kernel:
4581-----------------------------
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004582
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004583No specific requirements for U-Boot. Make sure you have some root
4584device (initial ramdisk, NFS) for your target system.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004585
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004586
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004587Building a Linux Image:
4588-----------------------
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004589
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004590With U-Boot, "normal" build targets like "zImage" or "bzImage" are
4591not used. If you use recent kernel source, a new build target
4592"uImage" will exist which automatically builds an image usable by
4593U-Boot. Most older kernels also have support for a "pImage" target,
4594which was introduced for our predecessor project PPCBoot and uses a
4595100% compatible format.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004596
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004597Example:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004598
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004599 make TQM850L_config
4600 make oldconfig
4601 make dep
4602 make uImage
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004603
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004604The "uImage" build target uses a special tool (in 'tools/mkimage') to
4605encapsulate a compressed Linux kernel image with header information,
4606CRC32 checksum etc. for use with U-Boot. This is what we are doing:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004607
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004608* build a standard "vmlinux" kernel image (in ELF binary format):
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004609
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004610* convert the kernel into a raw binary image:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004611
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004612 ${CROSS_COMPILE}-objcopy -O binary \
4613 -R .note -R .comment \
4614 -S vmlinux linux.bin
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004615
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004616* compress the binary image:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004617
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004618 gzip -9 linux.bin
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004619
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004620* package compressed binary image for U-Boot:
wdenk24ee89b2002-11-03 17:56:27 +00004621
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004622 mkimage -A ppc -O linux -T kernel -C gzip \
4623 -a 0 -e 0 -n "Linux Kernel Image" \
4624 -d linux.bin.gz uImage
wdenk24ee89b2002-11-03 17:56:27 +00004625
wdenk24ee89b2002-11-03 17:56:27 +00004626
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004627The "mkimage" tool can also be used to create ramdisk images for use
4628with U-Boot, either separated from the Linux kernel image, or
4629combined into one file. "mkimage" encapsulates the images with a 64
4630byte header containing information about target architecture,
4631operating system, image type, compression method, entry points, time
4632stamp, CRC32 checksums, etc.
wdenk24ee89b2002-11-03 17:56:27 +00004633
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004634"mkimage" can be called in two ways: to verify existing images and
4635print the header information, or to build new images.
wdenk24ee89b2002-11-03 17:56:27 +00004636
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004637In the first form (with "-l" option) mkimage lists the information
4638contained in the header of an existing U-Boot image; this includes
4639checksum verification:
wdenk24ee89b2002-11-03 17:56:27 +00004640
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004641 tools/mkimage -l image
4642 -l ==> list image header information
wdenk24ee89b2002-11-03 17:56:27 +00004643
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004644The second form (with "-d" option) is used to build a U-Boot image
4645from a "data file" which is used as image payload:
wdenk24ee89b2002-11-03 17:56:27 +00004646
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004647 tools/mkimage -A arch -O os -T type -C comp -a addr -e ep \
4648 -n name -d data_file image
4649 -A ==> set architecture to 'arch'
4650 -O ==> set operating system to 'os'
4651 -T ==> set image type to 'type'
4652 -C ==> set compression type 'comp'
4653 -a ==> set load address to 'addr' (hex)
4654 -e ==> set entry point to 'ep' (hex)
4655 -n ==> set image name to 'name'
4656 -d ==> use image data from 'datafile'
wdenk24ee89b2002-11-03 17:56:27 +00004657
wdenk69459792004-05-29 16:53:29 +00004658Right now, all Linux kernels for PowerPC systems use the same load
4659address (0x00000000), but the entry point address depends on the
4660kernel version:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004661
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004662- 2.2.x kernels have the entry point at 0x0000000C,
4663- 2.3.x and later kernels have the entry point at 0x00000000.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004664
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004665So a typical call to build a U-Boot image would read:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004666
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004667 -> tools/mkimage -n '2.4.4 kernel for TQM850L' \
4668 > -A ppc -O linux -T kernel -C gzip -a 0 -e 0 \
Stefan Roesea47a12b2010-04-15 16:07:28 +02004669 > -d /opt/elsk/ppc_8xx/usr/src/linux-2.4.4/arch/powerpc/coffboot/vmlinux.gz \
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004670 > examples/uImage.TQM850L
4671 Image Name: 2.4.4 kernel for TQM850L
4672 Created: Wed Jul 19 02:34:59 2000
4673 Image Type: PowerPC Linux Kernel Image (gzip compressed)
4674 Data Size: 335725 Bytes = 327.86 kB = 0.32 MB
4675 Load Address: 0x00000000
4676 Entry Point: 0x00000000
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004677
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004678To verify the contents of the image (or check for corruption):
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004679
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004680 -> tools/mkimage -l examples/uImage.TQM850L
4681 Image Name: 2.4.4 kernel for TQM850L
4682 Created: Wed Jul 19 02:34:59 2000
4683 Image Type: PowerPC Linux Kernel Image (gzip compressed)
4684 Data Size: 335725 Bytes = 327.86 kB = 0.32 MB
4685 Load Address: 0x00000000
4686 Entry Point: 0x00000000
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004687
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004688NOTE: for embedded systems where boot time is critical you can trade
4689speed for memory and install an UNCOMPRESSED image instead: this
4690needs more space in Flash, but boots much faster since it does not
4691need to be uncompressed:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004692
Stefan Roesea47a12b2010-04-15 16:07:28 +02004693 -> gunzip /opt/elsk/ppc_8xx/usr/src/linux-2.4.4/arch/powerpc/coffboot/vmlinux.gz
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004694 -> tools/mkimage -n '2.4.4 kernel for TQM850L' \
4695 > -A ppc -O linux -T kernel -C none -a 0 -e 0 \
Stefan Roesea47a12b2010-04-15 16:07:28 +02004696 > -d /opt/elsk/ppc_8xx/usr/src/linux-2.4.4/arch/powerpc/coffboot/vmlinux \
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004697 > examples/uImage.TQM850L-uncompressed
4698 Image Name: 2.4.4 kernel for TQM850L
4699 Created: Wed Jul 19 02:34:59 2000
4700 Image Type: PowerPC Linux Kernel Image (uncompressed)
4701 Data Size: 792160 Bytes = 773.59 kB = 0.76 MB
4702 Load Address: 0x00000000
4703 Entry Point: 0x00000000
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004704
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004705
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004706Similar you can build U-Boot images from a 'ramdisk.image.gz' file
4707when your kernel is intended to use an initial ramdisk:
wdenkdb01a2e2004-04-15 23:14:49 +00004708
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004709 -> tools/mkimage -n 'Simple Ramdisk Image' \
4710 > -A ppc -O linux -T ramdisk -C gzip \
4711 > -d /LinuxPPC/images/SIMPLE-ramdisk.image.gz examples/simple-initrd
4712 Image Name: Simple Ramdisk Image
4713 Created: Wed Jan 12 14:01:50 2000
4714 Image Type: PowerPC Linux RAMDisk Image (gzip compressed)
4715 Data Size: 566530 Bytes = 553.25 kB = 0.54 MB
4716 Load Address: 0x00000000
4717 Entry Point: 0x00000000
wdenkdb01a2e2004-04-15 23:14:49 +00004718
wdenkdb01a2e2004-04-15 23:14:49 +00004719
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004720Installing a Linux Image:
4721-------------------------
wdenkdb01a2e2004-04-15 23:14:49 +00004722
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004723To downloading a U-Boot image over the serial (console) interface,
4724you must convert the image to S-Record format:
wdenkdb01a2e2004-04-15 23:14:49 +00004725
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004726 objcopy -I binary -O srec examples/image examples/image.srec
wdenkdb01a2e2004-04-15 23:14:49 +00004727
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004728The 'objcopy' does not understand the information in the U-Boot
4729image header, so the resulting S-Record file will be relative to
4730address 0x00000000. To load it to a given address, you need to
4731specify the target address as 'offset' parameter with the 'loads'
4732command.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004733
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004734Example: install the image to address 0x40100000 (which on the
4735TQM8xxL is in the first Flash bank):
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004736
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004737 => erase 40100000 401FFFFF
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004738
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004739 .......... done
4740 Erased 8 sectors
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004741
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004742 => loads 40100000
4743 ## Ready for S-Record download ...
4744 ~>examples/image.srec
4745 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 ...
4746 ...
4747 15989 15990 15991 15992
4748 [file transfer complete]
4749 [connected]
4750 ## Start Addr = 0x00000000
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004751
4752
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004753You can check the success of the download using the 'iminfo' command;
Wolfgang Denk218ca722008-03-26 10:40:12 +01004754this includes a checksum verification so you can be sure no data
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004755corruption happened:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004756
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004757 => imi 40100000
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004758
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004759 ## Checking Image at 40100000 ...
4760 Image Name: 2.2.13 for initrd on TQM850L
4761 Image Type: PowerPC Linux Kernel Image (gzip compressed)
4762 Data Size: 335725 Bytes = 327 kB = 0 MB
4763 Load Address: 00000000
4764 Entry Point: 0000000c
4765 Verifying Checksum ... OK
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004766
4767
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004768Boot Linux:
4769-----------
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004770
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004771The "bootm" command is used to boot an application that is stored in
4772memory (RAM or Flash). In case of a Linux kernel image, the contents
4773of the "bootargs" environment variable is passed to the kernel as
4774parameters. You can check and modify this variable using the
4775"printenv" and "setenv" commands:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004776
4777
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004778 => printenv bootargs
4779 bootargs=root=/dev/ram
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004780
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004781 => setenv bootargs root=/dev/nfs rw nfsroot=10.0.0.2:/LinuxPPC nfsaddrs=10.0.0.99:10.0.0.2
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004782
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004783 => printenv bootargs
4784 bootargs=root=/dev/nfs rw nfsroot=10.0.0.2:/LinuxPPC nfsaddrs=10.0.0.99:10.0.0.2
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004785
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004786 => bootm 40020000
4787 ## Booting Linux kernel at 40020000 ...
4788 Image Name: 2.2.13 for NFS on TQM850L
4789 Image Type: PowerPC Linux Kernel Image (gzip compressed)
4790 Data Size: 381681 Bytes = 372 kB = 0 MB
4791 Load Address: 00000000
4792 Entry Point: 0000000c
4793 Verifying Checksum ... OK
4794 Uncompressing Kernel Image ... OK
4795 Linux version 2.2.13 (wd@denx.local.net) (gcc version 2.95.2 19991024 (release)) #1 Wed Jul 19 02:35:17 MEST 2000
4796 Boot arguments: root=/dev/nfs rw nfsroot=10.0.0.2:/LinuxPPC nfsaddrs=10.0.0.99:10.0.0.2
4797 time_init: decrementer frequency = 187500000/60
4798 Calibrating delay loop... 49.77 BogoMIPS
4799 Memory: 15208k available (700k kernel code, 444k data, 32k init) [c0000000,c1000000]
4800 ...
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004801
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02004802If you want to boot a Linux kernel with initial RAM disk, you pass
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004803the memory addresses of both the kernel and the initrd image (PPBCOOT
4804format!) to the "bootm" command:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004805
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004806 => imi 40100000 40200000
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004807
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004808 ## Checking Image at 40100000 ...
4809 Image Name: 2.2.13 for initrd on TQM850L
4810 Image Type: PowerPC Linux Kernel Image (gzip compressed)
4811 Data Size: 335725 Bytes = 327 kB = 0 MB
4812 Load Address: 00000000
4813 Entry Point: 0000000c
4814 Verifying Checksum ... OK
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004815
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004816 ## Checking Image at 40200000 ...
4817 Image Name: Simple Ramdisk Image
4818 Image Type: PowerPC Linux RAMDisk Image (gzip compressed)
4819 Data Size: 566530 Bytes = 553 kB = 0 MB
4820 Load Address: 00000000
4821 Entry Point: 00000000
4822 Verifying Checksum ... OK
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004823
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004824 => bootm 40100000 40200000
4825 ## Booting Linux kernel at 40100000 ...
4826 Image Name: 2.2.13 for initrd on TQM850L
4827 Image Type: PowerPC Linux Kernel Image (gzip compressed)
4828 Data Size: 335725 Bytes = 327 kB = 0 MB
4829 Load Address: 00000000
4830 Entry Point: 0000000c
4831 Verifying Checksum ... OK
4832 Uncompressing Kernel Image ... OK
4833 ## Loading RAMDisk Image at 40200000 ...
4834 Image Name: Simple Ramdisk Image
4835 Image Type: PowerPC Linux RAMDisk Image (gzip compressed)
4836 Data Size: 566530 Bytes = 553 kB = 0 MB
4837 Load Address: 00000000
4838 Entry Point: 00000000
4839 Verifying Checksum ... OK
4840 Loading Ramdisk ... OK
4841 Linux version 2.2.13 (wd@denx.local.net) (gcc version 2.95.2 19991024 (release)) #1 Wed Jul 19 02:32:08 MEST 2000
4842 Boot arguments: root=/dev/ram
4843 time_init: decrementer frequency = 187500000/60
4844 Calibrating delay loop... 49.77 BogoMIPS
4845 ...
4846 RAMDISK: Compressed image found at block 0
4847 VFS: Mounted root (ext2 filesystem).
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004848
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004849 bash#
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004850
Matthew McClintock02677682006-06-28 10:41:37 -05004851Boot Linux and pass a flat device tree:
4852-----------
4853
4854First, U-Boot must be compiled with the appropriate defines. See the section
4855titled "Linux Kernel Interface" above for a more in depth explanation. The
4856following is an example of how to start a kernel and pass an updated
4857flat device tree:
4858
4859=> print oftaddr
4860oftaddr=0x300000
4861=> print oft
4862oft=oftrees/mpc8540ads.dtb
4863=> tftp $oftaddr $oft
4864Speed: 1000, full duplex
4865Using TSEC0 device
4866TFTP from server 192.168.1.1; our IP address is 192.168.1.101
4867Filename 'oftrees/mpc8540ads.dtb'.
4868Load address: 0x300000
4869Loading: #
4870done
4871Bytes transferred = 4106 (100a hex)
4872=> tftp $loadaddr $bootfile
4873Speed: 1000, full duplex
4874Using TSEC0 device
4875TFTP from server 192.168.1.1; our IP address is 192.168.1.2
4876Filename 'uImage'.
4877Load address: 0x200000
4878Loading:############
4879done
4880Bytes transferred = 1029407 (fb51f hex)
4881=> print loadaddr
4882loadaddr=200000
4883=> print oftaddr
4884oftaddr=0x300000
4885=> bootm $loadaddr - $oftaddr
4886## Booting image at 00200000 ...
Wolfgang Denka9398e02006-11-27 15:32:42 +01004887 Image Name: Linux-2.6.17-dirty
4888 Image Type: PowerPC Linux Kernel Image (gzip compressed)
4889 Data Size: 1029343 Bytes = 1005.2 kB
Matthew McClintock02677682006-06-28 10:41:37 -05004890 Load Address: 00000000
Wolfgang Denka9398e02006-11-27 15:32:42 +01004891 Entry Point: 00000000
Matthew McClintock02677682006-06-28 10:41:37 -05004892 Verifying Checksum ... OK
4893 Uncompressing Kernel Image ... OK
4894Booting using flat device tree at 0x300000
4895Using MPC85xx ADS machine description
4896Memory CAM mapping: CAM0=256Mb, CAM1=256Mb, CAM2=0Mb residual: 0Mb
4897[snip]
4898
4899
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004900More About U-Boot Image Types:
4901------------------------------
wdenk6069ff22003-02-28 00:49:47 +00004902
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004903U-Boot supports the following image types:
wdenk6069ff22003-02-28 00:49:47 +00004904
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004905 "Standalone Programs" are directly runnable in the environment
4906 provided by U-Boot; it is expected that (if they behave
4907 well) you can continue to work in U-Boot after return from
4908 the Standalone Program.
4909 "OS Kernel Images" are usually images of some Embedded OS which
4910 will take over control completely. Usually these programs
4911 will install their own set of exception handlers, device
4912 drivers, set up the MMU, etc. - this means, that you cannot
4913 expect to re-enter U-Boot except by resetting the CPU.
4914 "RAMDisk Images" are more or less just data blocks, and their
4915 parameters (address, size) are passed to an OS kernel that is
4916 being started.
4917 "Multi-File Images" contain several images, typically an OS
4918 (Linux) kernel image and one or more data images like
4919 RAMDisks. This construct is useful for instance when you want
4920 to boot over the network using BOOTP etc., where the boot
4921 server provides just a single image file, but you want to get
4922 for instance an OS kernel and a RAMDisk image.
stroesec1551ea2003-04-04 15:53:41 +00004923
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004924 "Multi-File Images" start with a list of image sizes, each
4925 image size (in bytes) specified by an "uint32_t" in network
4926 byte order. This list is terminated by an "(uint32_t)0".
4927 Immediately after the terminating 0 follow the images, one by
4928 one, all aligned on "uint32_t" boundaries (size rounded up to
4929 a multiple of 4 bytes).
stroesec1551ea2003-04-04 15:53:41 +00004930
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004931 "Firmware Images" are binary images containing firmware (like
4932 U-Boot or FPGA images) which usually will be programmed to
4933 flash memory.
stroesec1551ea2003-04-04 15:53:41 +00004934
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004935 "Script files" are command sequences that will be executed by
4936 U-Boot's command interpreter; this feature is especially
4937 useful when you configure U-Boot to use a real shell (hush)
4938 as command interpreter.
wdenk6069ff22003-02-28 00:49:47 +00004939
Marek Vasut44f074c2012-03-14 21:52:45 +00004940Booting the Linux zImage:
4941-------------------------
4942
4943On some platforms, it's possible to boot Linux zImage. This is done
4944using the "bootz" command. The syntax of "bootz" command is the same
4945as the syntax of "bootm" command.
4946
Marek Vasut017e1f32012-03-18 11:47:58 +00004947Note, defining the CONFIG_SUPPORT_INITRD_RAW allows user to supply
4948kernel with raw initrd images. The syntax is slightly different, the
4949address of the initrd must be augmented by it's size, in the following
4950format: "<initrd addres>:<initrd size>".
4951
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004952
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004953Standalone HOWTO:
4954=================
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004955
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004956One of the features of U-Boot is that you can dynamically load and
4957run "standalone" applications, which can use some resources of
4958U-Boot like console I/O functions or interrupt services.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004959
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004960Two simple examples are included with the sources:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004961
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004962"Hello World" Demo:
4963-------------------
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004964
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004965'examples/hello_world.c' contains a small "Hello World" Demo
4966application; it is automatically compiled when you build U-Boot.
4967It's configured to run at address 0x00040004, so you can play with it
4968like that:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004969
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004970 => loads
4971 ## Ready for S-Record download ...
4972 ~>examples/hello_world.srec
4973 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 ...
4974 [file transfer complete]
4975 [connected]
4976 ## Start Addr = 0x00040004
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004977
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004978 => go 40004 Hello World! This is a test.
4979 ## Starting application at 0x00040004 ...
4980 Hello World
4981 argc = 7
4982 argv[0] = "40004"
4983 argv[1] = "Hello"
4984 argv[2] = "World!"
4985 argv[3] = "This"
4986 argv[4] = "is"
4987 argv[5] = "a"
4988 argv[6] = "test."
4989 argv[7] = "<NULL>"
4990 Hit any key to exit ...
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004991
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004992 ## Application terminated, rc = 0x0
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00004993
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00004994Another example, which demonstrates how to register a CPM interrupt
4995handler with the U-Boot code, can be found in 'examples/timer.c'.
4996Here, a CPM timer is set up to generate an interrupt every second.
4997The interrupt service routine is trivial, just printing a '.'
4998character, but this is just a demo program. The application can be
4999controlled by the following keys:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005000
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005001 ? - print current values og the CPM Timer registers
5002 b - enable interrupts and start timer
5003 e - stop timer and disable interrupts
5004 q - quit application
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005005
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005006 => loads
5007 ## Ready for S-Record download ...
5008 ~>examples/timer.srec
5009 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 ...
5010 [file transfer complete]
5011 [connected]
5012 ## Start Addr = 0x00040004
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005013
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005014 => go 40004
5015 ## Starting application at 0x00040004 ...
5016 TIMERS=0xfff00980
5017 Using timer 1
5018 tgcr @ 0xfff00980, tmr @ 0xfff00990, trr @ 0xfff00994, tcr @ 0xfff00998, tcn @ 0xfff0099c, ter @ 0xfff009b0
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005019
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005020Hit 'b':
5021 [q, b, e, ?] Set interval 1000000 us
5022 Enabling timer
5023Hit '?':
5024 [q, b, e, ?] ........
5025 tgcr=0x1, tmr=0xff1c, trr=0x3d09, tcr=0x0, tcn=0xef6, ter=0x0
5026Hit '?':
5027 [q, b, e, ?] .
5028 tgcr=0x1, tmr=0xff1c, trr=0x3d09, tcr=0x0, tcn=0x2ad4, ter=0x0
5029Hit '?':
5030 [q, b, e, ?] .
5031 tgcr=0x1, tmr=0xff1c, trr=0x3d09, tcr=0x0, tcn=0x1efc, ter=0x0
5032Hit '?':
5033 [q, b, e, ?] .
5034 tgcr=0x1, tmr=0xff1c, trr=0x3d09, tcr=0x0, tcn=0x169d, ter=0x0
5035Hit 'e':
5036 [q, b, e, ?] ...Stopping timer
5037Hit 'q':
5038 [q, b, e, ?] ## Application terminated, rc = 0x0
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005039
5040
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005041Minicom warning:
5042================
wdenk85ec0bc2003-03-31 16:34:49 +00005043
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005044Over time, many people have reported problems when trying to use the
5045"minicom" terminal emulation program for serial download. I (wd)
5046consider minicom to be broken, and recommend not to use it. Under
5047Unix, I recommend to use C-Kermit for general purpose use (and
5048especially for kermit binary protocol download ("loadb" command), and
Karl O. Pince53515a2012-10-01 05:11:56 +00005049use "cu" for S-Record download ("loads" command). See
5050http://www.denx.de/wiki/view/DULG/SystemSetup#Section_4.3.
5051for help with kermit.
5052
wdenk85ec0bc2003-03-31 16:34:49 +00005053
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005054Nevertheless, if you absolutely want to use it try adding this
5055configuration to your "File transfer protocols" section:
wdenk52f52c12003-06-19 23:04:19 +00005056
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005057 Name Program Name U/D FullScr IO-Red. Multi
5058 X kermit /usr/bin/kermit -i -l %l -s Y U Y N N
5059 Y kermit /usr/bin/kermit -i -l %l -r N D Y N N
wdenk52f52c12003-06-19 23:04:19 +00005060
5061
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005062NetBSD Notes:
5063=============
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005064
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005065Starting at version 0.9.2, U-Boot supports NetBSD both as host
5066(build U-Boot) and target system (boots NetBSD/mpc8xx).
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005067
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005068Building requires a cross environment; it is known to work on
5069NetBSD/i386 with the cross-powerpc-netbsd-1.3 package (you will also
5070need gmake since the Makefiles are not compatible with BSD make).
5071Note that the cross-powerpc package does not install include files;
5072attempting to build U-Boot will fail because <machine/ansi.h> is
5073missing. This file has to be installed and patched manually:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005074
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005075 # cd /usr/pkg/cross/powerpc-netbsd/include
5076 # mkdir powerpc
5077 # ln -s powerpc machine
5078 # cp /usr/src/sys/arch/powerpc/include/ansi.h powerpc/ansi.h
5079 # ${EDIT} powerpc/ansi.h ## must remove __va_list, _BSD_VA_LIST
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005080
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005081Native builds *don't* work due to incompatibilities between native
5082and U-Boot include files.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005083
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005084Booting assumes that (the first part of) the image booted is a
5085stage-2 loader which in turn loads and then invokes the kernel
5086proper. Loader sources will eventually appear in the NetBSD source
5087tree (probably in sys/arc/mpc8xx/stand/u-boot_stage2/); in the
wdenk2a8af182005-04-13 10:02:42 +00005088meantime, see ftp://ftp.denx.de/pub/u-boot/ppcboot_stage2.tar.gz
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005089
5090
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005091Implementation Internals:
5092=========================
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005093
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005094The following is not intended to be a complete description of every
5095implementation detail. However, it should help to understand the
5096inner workings of U-Boot and make it easier to port it to custom
5097hardware.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005098
5099
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005100Initial Stack, Global Data:
5101---------------------------
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005102
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005103The implementation of U-Boot is complicated by the fact that U-Boot
5104starts running out of ROM (flash memory), usually without access to
5105system RAM (because the memory controller is not initialized yet).
5106This means that we don't have writable Data or BSS segments, and BSS
5107is not initialized as zero. To be able to get a C environment working
5108at all, we have to allocate at least a minimal stack. Implementation
5109options for this are defined and restricted by the CPU used: Some CPU
5110models provide on-chip memory (like the IMMR area on MPC8xx and
5111MPC826x processors), on others (parts of) the data cache can be
5112locked as (mis-) used as memory, etc.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005113
Wolfgang Denk218ca722008-03-26 10:40:12 +01005114 Chris Hallinan posted a good summary of these issues to the
Wolfgang Denk06682362008-12-30 22:56:11 +01005115 U-Boot mailing list:
wdenk43d96162003-03-06 00:02:04 +00005116
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005117 Subject: RE: [U-Boot-Users] RE: More On Memory Bank x (nothingness)?
5118 From: "Chris Hallinan" <clh@net1plus.com>
5119 Date: Mon, 10 Feb 2003 16:43:46 -0500 (22:43 MET)
5120 ...
wdenk43d96162003-03-06 00:02:04 +00005121
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005122 Correct me if I'm wrong, folks, but the way I understand it
5123 is this: Using DCACHE as initial RAM for Stack, etc, does not
5124 require any physical RAM backing up the cache. The cleverness
5125 is that the cache is being used as a temporary supply of
5126 necessary storage before the SDRAM controller is setup. It's
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02005127 beyond the scope of this list to explain the details, but you
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005128 can see how this works by studying the cache architecture and
5129 operation in the architecture and processor-specific manuals.
wdenk43d96162003-03-06 00:02:04 +00005130
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005131 OCM is On Chip Memory, which I believe the 405GP has 4K. It
5132 is another option for the system designer to use as an
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02005133 initial stack/RAM area prior to SDRAM being available. Either
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005134 option should work for you. Using CS 4 should be fine if your
5135 board designers haven't used it for something that would
5136 cause you grief during the initial boot! It is frequently not
5137 used.
wdenk43d96162003-03-06 00:02:04 +00005138
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02005139 CONFIG_SYS_INIT_RAM_ADDR should be somewhere that won't interfere
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005140 with your processor/board/system design. The default value
5141 you will find in any recent u-boot distribution in
Stefan Roese8a316c92005-08-01 16:49:12 +02005142 walnut.h should work for you. I'd set it to a value larger
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005143 than your SDRAM module. If you have a 64MB SDRAM module, set
5144 it above 400_0000. Just make sure your board has no resources
5145 that are supposed to respond to that address! That code in
5146 start.S has been around a while and should work as is when
5147 you get the config right.
wdenk43d96162003-03-06 00:02:04 +00005148
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005149 -Chris Hallinan
5150 DS4.COM, Inc.
wdenk43d96162003-03-06 00:02:04 +00005151
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005152It is essential to remember this, since it has some impact on the C
5153code for the initialization procedures:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005154
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005155* Initialized global data (data segment) is read-only. Do not attempt
5156 to write it.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005157
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02005158* Do not use any uninitialized global data (or implicitely initialized
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005159 as zero data - BSS segment) at all - this is undefined, initiali-
5160 zation is performed later (when relocating to RAM).
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005161
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005162* Stack space is very limited. Avoid big data buffers or things like
5163 that.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005164
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005165Having only the stack as writable memory limits means we cannot use
5166normal global data to share information beween the code. But it
5167turned out that the implementation of U-Boot can be greatly
5168simplified by making a global data structure (gd_t) available to all
5169functions. We could pass a pointer to this data as argument to _all_
5170functions, but this would bloat the code. Instead we use a feature of
5171the GCC compiler (Global Register Variables) to share the data: we
5172place a pointer (gd) to the global data into a register which we
5173reserve for this purpose.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005174
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005175When choosing a register for such a purpose we are restricted by the
5176relevant (E)ABI specifications for the current architecture, and by
5177GCC's implementation.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005178
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005179For PowerPC, the following registers have specific use:
5180 R1: stack pointer
Wolfgang Denke7670f62008-02-14 22:43:22 +01005181 R2: reserved for system use
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005182 R3-R4: parameter passing and return values
5183 R5-R10: parameter passing
5184 R13: small data area pointer
5185 R30: GOT pointer
5186 R31: frame pointer
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005187
Joakim Tjernlunde6bee802010-01-19 14:41:58 +01005188 (U-Boot also uses R12 as internal GOT pointer. r12
5189 is a volatile register so r12 needs to be reset when
5190 going back and forth between asm and C)
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005191
Wolfgang Denke7670f62008-02-14 22:43:22 +01005192 ==> U-Boot will use R2 to hold a pointer to the global data
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005193
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005194 Note: on PPC, we could use a static initializer (since the
5195 address of the global data structure is known at compile time),
5196 but it turned out that reserving a register results in somewhat
5197 smaller code - although the code savings are not that big (on
5198 average for all boards 752 bytes for the whole U-Boot image,
5199 624 text + 127 data).
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005200
Robin Getzc4db3352009-08-17 15:23:02 +00005201On Blackfin, the normal C ABI (except for P3) is followed as documented here:
Mike Frysinger4c58eb52008-02-04 19:26:54 -05005202 http://docs.blackfin.uclinux.org/doku.php?id=application_binary_interface
5203
Robin Getzc4db3352009-08-17 15:23:02 +00005204 ==> U-Boot will use P3 to hold a pointer to the global data
Mike Frysinger4c58eb52008-02-04 19:26:54 -05005205
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005206On ARM, the following registers are used:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005207
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005208 R0: function argument word/integer result
5209 R1-R3: function argument word
5210 R9: GOT pointer
5211 R10: stack limit (used only if stack checking if enabled)
5212 R11: argument (frame) pointer
5213 R12: temporary workspace
5214 R13: stack pointer
5215 R14: link register
5216 R15: program counter
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005217
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005218 ==> U-Boot will use R8 to hold a pointer to the global data
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005219
Thomas Chou0df01fd2010-05-21 11:08:03 +08005220On Nios II, the ABI is documented here:
5221 http://www.altera.com/literature/hb/nios2/n2cpu_nii51016.pdf
5222
5223 ==> U-Boot will use gp to hold a pointer to the global data
5224
5225 Note: on Nios II, we give "-G0" option to gcc and don't use gp
5226 to access small data sections, so gp is free.
5227
Macpaul Linafc1ce82011-10-19 20:41:11 +00005228On NDS32, the following registers are used:
5229
5230 R0-R1: argument/return
5231 R2-R5: argument
5232 R15: temporary register for assembler
5233 R16: trampoline register
5234 R28: frame pointer (FP)
5235 R29: global pointer (GP)
5236 R30: link register (LP)
5237 R31: stack pointer (SP)
5238 PC: program counter (PC)
5239
5240 ==> U-Boot will use R10 to hold a pointer to the global data
5241
Wolfgang Denkd87080b2006-03-31 18:32:53 +02005242NOTE: DECLARE_GLOBAL_DATA_PTR must be used with file-global scope,
5243or current versions of GCC may "optimize" the code too much.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005244
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005245Memory Management:
5246------------------
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005247
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005248U-Boot runs in system state and uses physical addresses, i.e. the
5249MMU is not used either for address mapping nor for memory protection.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005250
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005251The available memory is mapped to fixed addresses using the memory
5252controller. In this process, a contiguous block is formed for each
5253memory type (Flash, SDRAM, SRAM), even when it consists of several
5254physical memory banks.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005255
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005256U-Boot is installed in the first 128 kB of the first Flash bank (on
5257TQM8xxL modules this is the range 0x40000000 ... 0x4001FFFF). After
5258booting and sizing and initializing DRAM, the code relocates itself
5259to the upper end of DRAM. Immediately below the U-Boot code some
Jean-Christophe PLAGNIOL-VILLARD6d0f6bc2008-10-16 15:01:15 +02005260memory is reserved for use by malloc() [see CONFIG_SYS_MALLOC_LEN
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005261configuration setting]. Below that, a structure with global Board
5262Info data is placed, followed by the stack (growing downward).
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005263
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005264Additionally, some exception handler code is copied to the low 8 kB
5265of DRAM (0x00000000 ... 0x00001FFF).
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005266
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005267So a typical memory configuration with 16 MB of DRAM could look like
5268this:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005269
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005270 0x0000 0000 Exception Vector code
5271 :
5272 0x0000 1FFF
5273 0x0000 2000 Free for Application Use
5274 :
5275 :
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005276
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005277 :
5278 :
5279 0x00FB FF20 Monitor Stack (Growing downward)
5280 0x00FB FFAC Board Info Data and permanent copy of global data
5281 0x00FC 0000 Malloc Arena
5282 :
5283 0x00FD FFFF
5284 0x00FE 0000 RAM Copy of Monitor Code
5285 ... eventually: LCD or video framebuffer
5286 ... eventually: pRAM (Protected RAM - unchanged by reset)
5287 0x00FF FFFF [End of RAM]
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005288
5289
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005290System Initialization:
5291----------------------
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005292
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005293In the reset configuration, U-Boot starts at the reset entry point
Marcel Ziswiler11ccc332008-07-09 08:17:15 +02005294(on most PowerPC systems at address 0x00000100). Because of the reset
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005295configuration for CS0# this is a mirror of the onboard Flash memory.
5296To be able to re-map memory U-Boot then jumps to its link address.
5297To be able to implement the initialization code in C, a (small!)
5298initial stack is set up in the internal Dual Ported RAM (in case CPUs
5299which provide such a feature like MPC8xx or MPC8260), or in a locked
5300part of the data cache. After that, U-Boot initializes the CPU core,
5301the caches and the SIU.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005302
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005303Next, all (potentially) available memory banks are mapped using a
5304preliminary mapping. For example, we put them on 512 MB boundaries
5305(multiples of 0x20000000: SDRAM on 0x00000000 and 0x20000000, Flash
5306on 0x40000000 and 0x60000000, SRAM on 0x80000000). Then UPM A is
5307programmed for SDRAM access. Using the temporary configuration, a
5308simple memory test is run that determines the size of the SDRAM
5309banks.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005310
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005311When there is more than one SDRAM bank, and the banks are of
5312different size, the largest is mapped first. For equal size, the first
5313bank (CS2#) is mapped first. The first mapping is always for address
53140x00000000, with any additional banks following immediately to create
5315contiguous memory starting from 0.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005316
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005317Then, the monitor installs itself at the upper end of the SDRAM area
5318and allocates memory for use by malloc() and for the global Board
5319Info data; also, the exception vector code is copied to the low RAM
5320pages, and the final stack is set up.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005321
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005322Only after this relocation will you have a "normal" C environment;
5323until that you are restricted in several ways, mostly because you are
5324running from ROM, and because the code will have to be relocated to a
5325new address in RAM.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005326
5327
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005328U-Boot Porting Guide:
5329----------------------
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005330
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005331[Based on messages by Jerry Van Baren in the U-Boot-Users mailing
5332list, October 2002]
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005333
5334
Jerry Van Baren6c3fef22009-07-15 20:42:59 -04005335int main(int argc, char *argv[])
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005336{
5337 sighandler_t no_more_time;
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005338
Jerry Van Baren6c3fef22009-07-15 20:42:59 -04005339 signal(SIGALRM, no_more_time);
5340 alarm(PROJECT_DEADLINE - toSec (3 * WEEK));
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005341
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005342 if (available_money > available_manpower) {
Jerry Van Baren6c3fef22009-07-15 20:42:59 -04005343 Pay consultant to port U-Boot;
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005344 return 0;
5345 }
5346
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005347 Download latest U-Boot source;
5348
Wolfgang Denk06682362008-12-30 22:56:11 +01005349 Subscribe to u-boot mailing list;
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005350
Jerry Van Baren6c3fef22009-07-15 20:42:59 -04005351 if (clueless)
5352 email("Hi, I am new to U-Boot, how do I get started?");
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005353
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005354 while (learning) {
5355 Read the README file in the top level directory;
Jerry Van Baren6c3fef22009-07-15 20:42:59 -04005356 Read http://www.denx.de/twiki/bin/view/DULG/Manual;
5357 Read applicable doc/*.README;
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005358 Read the source, Luke;
Jerry Van Baren6c3fef22009-07-15 20:42:59 -04005359 /* find . -name "*.[chS]" | xargs grep -i <keyword> */
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005360 }
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005361
Jerry Van Baren6c3fef22009-07-15 20:42:59 -04005362 if (available_money > toLocalCurrency ($2500))
5363 Buy a BDI3000;
5364 else
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005365 Add a lot of aggravation and time;
Jerry Van Baren6c3fef22009-07-15 20:42:59 -04005366
5367 if (a similar board exists) { /* hopefully... */
5368 cp -a board/<similar> board/<myboard>
5369 cp include/configs/<similar>.h include/configs/<myboard>.h
5370 } else {
5371 Create your own board support subdirectory;
5372 Create your own board include/configs/<myboard>.h file;
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005373 }
Jerry Van Baren6c3fef22009-07-15 20:42:59 -04005374 Edit new board/<myboard> files
5375 Edit new include/configs/<myboard>.h
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005376
Jerry Van Baren6c3fef22009-07-15 20:42:59 -04005377 while (!accepted) {
5378 while (!running) {
5379 do {
5380 Add / modify source code;
5381 } until (compiles);
5382 Debug;
5383 if (clueless)
5384 email("Hi, I am having problems...");
5385 }
5386 Send patch file to the U-Boot email list;
5387 if (reasonable critiques)
5388 Incorporate improvements from email list code review;
5389 else
5390 Defend code as written;
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005391 }
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005392
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005393 return 0;
5394}
5395
5396void no_more_time (int sig)
5397{
5398 hire_a_guru();
5399}
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005400
5401
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005402Coding Standards:
5403-----------------
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005404
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005405All contributions to U-Boot should conform to the Linux kernel
Detlev Zundel2c051652006-09-01 15:39:02 +02005406coding style; see the file "Documentation/CodingStyle" and the script
Wolfgang Denk7ca92962011-07-27 10:59:55 +00005407"scripts/Lindent" in your Linux kernel source directory.
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005408
Detlev Zundel2c051652006-09-01 15:39:02 +02005409Source files originating from a different project (for example the
5410MTD subsystem) are generally exempt from these guidelines and are not
5411reformated to ease subsequent migration to newer versions of those
5412sources.
5413
5414Please note that U-Boot is implemented in C (and to some small parts in
5415Assembler); no C++ is used, so please do not use C++ style comments (//)
5416in your code.
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005417
5418Please also stick to the following formatting rules:
5419- remove any trailing white space
Wolfgang Denk7ca92962011-07-27 10:59:55 +00005420- use TAB characters for indentation and vertical alignment, not spaces
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005421- make sure NOT to use DOS '\r\n' line feeds
Wolfgang Denk7ca92962011-07-27 10:59:55 +00005422- do not add more than 2 consecutive empty lines to source files
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005423- do not add trailing empty lines to source files
5424
5425Submissions which do not conform to the standards may be returned
5426with a request to reformat the changes.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005427
5428
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005429Submitting Patches:
5430-------------------
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005431
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005432Since the number of patches for U-Boot is growing, we need to
5433establish some rules. Submissions which do not conform to these rules
5434may be rejected, even when they contain important and valuable stuff.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005435
Magnus Lilja0d28f342008-08-06 19:32:33 +02005436Please see http://www.denx.de/wiki/U-Boot/Patches for details.
Wolfgang Denk218ca722008-03-26 10:40:12 +01005437
Wolfgang Denk06682362008-12-30 22:56:11 +01005438Patches shall be sent to the u-boot mailing list <u-boot@lists.denx.de>;
5439see http://lists.denx.de/mailman/listinfo/u-boot
5440
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005441When you send a patch, please include the following information with
5442it:
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005443
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005444* For bug fixes: a description of the bug and how your patch fixes
5445 this bug. Please try to include a way of demonstrating that the
5446 patch actually fixes something.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005447
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005448* For new features: a description of the feature and your
5449 implementation.
wdenkc6097192002-11-03 00:24:07 +00005450
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005451* A CHANGELOG entry as plaintext (separate from the patch)
5452
5453* For major contributions, your entry to the CREDITS file
5454
5455* When you add support for a new board, don't forget to add this
Wolfgang Denk7ca92962011-07-27 10:59:55 +00005456 board to the MAINTAINERS file, too.
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005457
5458* If your patch adds new configuration options, don't forget to
5459 document these in the README file.
5460
Wolfgang Denk218ca722008-03-26 10:40:12 +01005461* The patch itself. If you are using git (which is *strongly*
5462 recommended) you can easily generate the patch using the
Wolfgang Denk7ca92962011-07-27 10:59:55 +00005463 "git format-patch". If you then use "git send-email" to send it to
Wolfgang Denk218ca722008-03-26 10:40:12 +01005464 the U-Boot mailing list, you will avoid most of the common problems
5465 with some other mail clients.
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005466
Wolfgang Denk218ca722008-03-26 10:40:12 +01005467 If you cannot use git, use "diff -purN OLD NEW". If your version of
5468 diff does not support these options, then get the latest version of
5469 GNU diff.
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005470
Wolfgang Denk218ca722008-03-26 10:40:12 +01005471 The current directory when running this command shall be the parent
5472 directory of the U-Boot source tree (i. e. please make sure that
5473 your patch includes sufficient directory information for the
5474 affected files).
5475
5476 We prefer patches as plain text. MIME attachments are discouraged,
5477 and compressed attachments must not be used.
wdenk2729af92004-05-03 20:45:30 +00005478
5479* If one logical set of modifications affects or creates several
5480 files, all these changes shall be submitted in a SINGLE patch file.
5481
5482* Changesets that contain different, unrelated modifications shall be
5483 submitted as SEPARATE patches, one patch per changeset.
5484
5485
5486Notes:
5487
5488* Before sending the patch, run the MAKEALL script on your patched
5489 source tree and make sure that no errors or warnings are reported
5490 for any of the boards.
5491
5492* Keep your modifications to the necessary minimum: A patch
5493 containing several unrelated changes or arbitrary reformats will be
5494 returned with a request to re-formatting / split it.
5495
5496* If you modify existing code, make sure that your new code does not
5497 add to the memory footprint of the code ;-) Small is beautiful!
5498 When adding new features, these should compile conditionally only
5499 (using #ifdef), and the resulting code with the new feature
5500 disabled must not need more memory than the old code without your
5501 modification.
wdenk90dc6702005-05-03 14:12:25 +00005502
Wolfgang Denk06682362008-12-30 22:56:11 +01005503* Remember that there is a size limit of 100 kB per message on the
5504 u-boot mailing list. Bigger patches will be moderated. If they are
5505 reasonable and not too big, they will be acknowledged. But patches
5506 bigger than the size limit should be avoided.